Download part 1: introduction - Vancouver Island Health Authority

Document related concepts

Transmission (medicine) wikipedia , lookup

Medical ethics wikipedia , lookup

Focal infection theory wikipedia , lookup

Infection wikipedia , lookup

Marburg virus disease wikipedia , lookup

Dysprosody wikipedia , lookup

Adherence (medicine) wikipedia , lookup

Patient safety wikipedia , lookup

Electronic prescribing wikipedia , lookup

Patient advocacy wikipedia , lookup

Infection control wikipedia , lookup

Transcript
INFECTION
PREVENTION AND CONTROL
MANUAL
September 1, 2011
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(Click here to see recent changes/additions)
PART 1: INTRODUCTION ................................................................................ 15
1. Purpose ...................................................................................................................... 15
2. Scope of the Document .............................................................................................. 15
3. Guiding Principles ....................................................................................................... 15
PART 2: UNDERSTANDING HOW INFECTIONS ARE SPREAD .................... 16
1. The Chain of Infection................................................................................................. 16
Figure 1: Chain of Infection ................................................................................. 16
A.
Causative Agents ............................................................................................... 17
B.
Reservoirs .......................................................................................................... 18
Table 1: Human Reservoirs and Transmission of Infectious Agents .............. 19
C.
Portal of Exit ....................................................................................................... 19
D.
Transmission ...................................................................................................... 20
1. Contact Transmission ............................................................................................. 20
2. Droplet Transmission .............................................................................................. 20
3. Airborne Transmission ............................................................................................ 20
4. Common Vehicle Transmission ............................................................................... 21
5. Vector Borne Transmission ..................................................................................... 21
E.
Portal of Entry ..................................................................................................... 21
F.
Susceptible Host................................................................................................. 22
PART 3: INFECTION PREVENTION AND CONTROL PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS................................................................................................. 25
1. ROUTINE PRACTICES .............................................................................................. 25
A.
Risk Assessment ................................................................................................ 25
1. Admission ............................................................................................................... 26
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 2
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Ongoing .................................................................................................................. 26
Figure 2: Risk Assessment Decision Tree - Acute Care ................................... 27
B.
Risk Reduction ................................................................................................... 28
1. Hand Hygiene ......................................................................................................... 28
Indications for Hand Hygiene .................................................................................. 28
Figure 3: The Four Moments of Hand Hygiene ................................................... 29
Nail and Skin Care .................................................................................................. 30
Type of Cleansing Agent ......................................................................................... 30
Alcohol Based Hand Rub ........................................................................................ 30
Soap and Water ...................................................................................................... 31
Handwashing Technique......................................................................................... 31
Table 2: Levels of Hand Disinfection .................................................................. 32
Hand Hygiene Procedure ........................................................................................ 32
Alcohol based hand rub technique .......................................................................... 32
Soap and Water hand washing technique ............................................................... 32
Surgical asepsis (scrub) technique with an alcohol based hand rub ........................ 33
Surgical asepsis technique with a medicated soap ................................................. 33
2. Respiratory Hygiene/Cough Etiquette ..................................................................... 34
3. Patient Placement ................................................................................................... 35
4. Personal Protective Equipment ............................................................................... 35
Gloves .................................................................................................................... 35
Table 3: Examples of Tasks that Require the Wearing of Gloves .................... 36
Table 4: Glove Use in Patient Care ...................................................................... 37
Figure 4: Choosing the Correct Glove ................................................................ 38
Gowns/Aprons ........................................................................................................ 39
Masks, Visors and Protective Eyewear ................................................................... 40
5. Hair/Jewelry/Uniforms ............................................................................................. 41
Hair ......................................................................................................................... 41
Jewelry ................................................................................................................... 41
Footwear ................................................................................................................. 41
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 3
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Dress Code for Staff Who Do Not Wear a Uniform, Including Medical Staff ............ 41
Dress Code for Staff Wearing a Uniform ................................................................. 41
6. Safe Handling of Sharps ......................................................................................... 42
7. Decontamination ..................................................................................................... 43
Cleaning.................................................................................................................. 43
Table 5: Reprocessing Decision Chart ............................................................... 43
Disinfection ............................................................................................................. 45
Table 6: Classes of Organisms in Order of Susceptibility to Disinfectants ... 46
Table 7: Disinfection Requirements for Equipment .......................................... 47
Table 8: Advantages and Disadvantages of Major Chemical Disinfectants ... 47
Sterilization ............................................................................................................. 49
Storage ................................................................................................................... 50
Event Related Sterility ............................................................................................. 50
8. Housekeeping ......................................................................................................... 51
9. Laundry ................................................................................................................... 51
Soiled Linen ............................................................................................................ 51
Laundering on the Units .......................................................................................... 52
Clean Linen ............................................................................................................. 52
Handling Soiled Linen contaminated with Hazardous Materials .............................. 53
10. Waste ..................................................................................................................... 54
Biohazardous Waste ............................................................................................... 55
Spillage of Blood or Body Fluids ............................................................................. 55
Waste Containers ................................................................................................... 56
11. Managing Dishes, Glasses, Cups and Eating Utensils ............................................ 56
Managing Tray Delivery – Procedures Specific to Additional Precautions ............... 57
12. Healthy Workplace .................................................................................................. 59
13. Recreational Reading Material and Games ............................................................. 59
C.
Education............................................................................................................ 60
2. ADDITIONAL PRECAUTIONS ................................................................................... 61
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 4
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
A.
Contact Precautions ........................................................................................... 61
1. Purpose .................................................................................................................. 61
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement ................................................................ 62
3. Contact Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors ........................................ 63
B.
Droplet Precautions ............................................................................................ 64
1. Purpose .................................................................................................................. 64
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement ................................................................ 64
3. Droplet Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors ........................................ 64
C.
Airborne Precautions .......................................................................................... 65
1. Purpose .................................................................................................................. 65
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement ................................................................ 66
3. Airborne Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors ...................................... 66
4. Actions when Negative Pressure Room Not Available or Malfunctions ................... 68
D.
SUMMARY OF PRECAUTIONS ........................................................................ 69
Table 9: Precautions Table .................................................................................. 69
E.
Protective (Reverse) Precautions ....................................................................... 70
Procedure ............................................................................................................... 70
F.
Management of Cases on Additional Precautions in Diagnostic Areas .............. 71
Figure 5: Management of Infected Patients/Residents on Precautions in
Diagnostic Areas .................................................................................................... 72
G.
Discontinuing Additional Precautions ................................................................. 73
Table 10: Procedure for Discontinuing Additional Precautions ...................... 73
PART 4: HOUSEKEEPING............................................................................... 74
1. Clean Environment ..................................................................................................... 74
A.
ROUTINE CLEANING ........................................................................................ 76
1. DAILY CLEAN......................................................................................................... 76
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN .............................................................................................. 79
3. ROUTINE PLUS DISCHARGE CLEAN ................................................................... 80
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 5
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
B.
ENHANCED CLEANING .................................................................................... 81
1. DAILY CLEAN......................................................................................................... 81
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN .............................................................................................. 82
C.
TWO STEP CLEANING ..................................................................................... 84
1. TWICE DAILY CLEAN ............................................................................................ 84
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN .............................................................................................. 85
D.
SEPARATION OF CLEAN AND SOILED EQUIPMENT ..................................... 86
Table 11: Summary of Cleaning Requirements ................................................. 88
2. Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology ......................................................................... 89
3. Bed Bug Infestation .................................................................................................... 90
Summary of Bed Bug Information ........................................................................... 90
Signs of Infestation ................................................................................................. 90
Key Procedures ...................................................................................................... 90
PART 5: ANTIBIOTIC RESISTANT ORGANISMS............................................ 92
1. Introduction ................................................................................................................. 92
2. Definitions ................................................................................................................... 92
Colonization ............................................................................................................ 92
Infection .................................................................................................................. 92
3. Acute Care Screening Protocol .................................................................................. 92
Figure 6: Patient Record Disease Alert Field ..................................................... 93
Table 12: List of Organisms with Corresponding Precautions and Other
Considerations ....................................................................................................... 94
4. ARO Screening and Collecting Swabs ....................................................................... 95
Table 13: Screening and Specimen Collection .................................................. 95
5. Overview of Antibiotic Resistant Organisms ............................................................... 95
A.
Methicillin-Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA) ........................................ 96
B.
Vancomycin-Resistant Enterococci (VRE) ......................................................... 96
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 6
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
C.
Extended Spectrum Beta-Lactamase (ESBL) Organisms .................................. 97
6. ARO Room Placement ............................................................................................... 98
Figure 7: ARO Room Placement .......................................................................... 98
Special Considerations in Bed Placement for VRE .................................................... 99
7. Key Management Issues ............................................................................................ 99
Table 14: Key Management Issues for MRSA and ESBL ................................... 99
PART 6: OUTBREAK MANAGEMENT ........................................................... 105
1. Introduction ............................................................................................................... 105
2. General Guidelines for Outbreak Management ........................................................ 106
A.
Reporting a Suspected Outbreak ..................................................................... 106
Table 15: Contact List .......................................................................................... 106
1. Initial Infection Prevention and Control Precautions .............................................. 106
Figure 8: Suspected Respiratory Infection or Gastroenteritis Outbreak
Algorithm .............................................................................................................. 108
2. Confirming an Outbreak ........................................................................................ 109
3. Outbreak Management ......................................................................................... 109
4. Compiling a Post-Outbreak Investigation Summary .............................................. 109
B.
Influenza-Like Illness (ILI) Outbreaks ............................................................... 109
1. Introduction ........................................................................................................... 109
2. Confirming an ILI Outbreak ................................................................................... 110
Table 16: Common Differences between Influenza and Common Cold
Symptoms ............................................................................................................. 110
Table 17: Respiratory Infections ........................................................................ 111
Table 18: Case Definition for ILI and an ILI Outbreak ..................................... 113
3. ILI Outbreak Management .................................................................................... 113
Practices and Precautions .................................................................................... 113
Room/Unit Closures .............................................................................................. 114
Patient Line Listings .............................................................................................. 114
Staff Line Listings.................................................................................................. 114
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 7
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Lost Bed Days....................................................................................................... 115
Restrictions on Patient Activities ........................................................................... 115
Working Restrictions for Asymptomatic Healthcare Workers ................................. 115
Working Restrictions for Symptomatic Healthcare Workers................................... 116
Students................................................................................................................ 116
Visitors/ Volunteers ............................................................................................... 117
Meals .................................................................................................................... 117
Pets ...................................................................................................................... 117
Housekeeping ....................................................................................................... 117
Linen ..................................................................................................................... 117
Collection and Transportation of Nasopharyngeal Swabs ..................................... 118
Prophylaxis for Laboratory Confirmed Influenza .................................................... 120
C.
Gastrointestinal Illness (GI) Outbreaks ............................................................. 120
1. Introduction ........................................................................................................... 120
2. Confirming a GI Outbreak ..................................................................................... 120
Table 19: Common Bacterial and Viral Causes of Gastroenteritis ................ 121
Table 20: Gastrointestinal Illness Case Definition .......................................... 122
3. GI Outbreak Management ..................................................................................... 122
Practices and Precautions .................................................................................... 123
Room/Unit Closures .............................................................................................. 123
Patient Line Listings .............................................................................................. 123
Staff Line Listings.................................................................................................. 124
Lost Bed Days....................................................................................................... 124
Restrictions on Patient Activities ........................................................................... 125
Working Restrictions for Staff ................................................................................ 125
Students................................................................................................................ 125
Visitors/ Volunteers ............................................................................................... 126
Meals .................................................................................................................... 126
Pets ...................................................................................................................... 126
Housekeeping ....................................................................................................... 126
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 8
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Linen ..................................................................................................................... 126
Collection and Transportation of Stool Specimens ................................................ 127
Obtaining An Outbreak Number ............................................................................ 127
How To Collect A Stool Specimen......................................................................... 127
Figure 9: Requisition Form for GI Testing ........................................................ 128
D.
Outbreaks Caused by Other Organisms ........................................................... 129
1. Clostridium Difficile Outbreak ................................................................................ 129
Confirming a CDI Outbreak ................................................................................... 129
Laboratory samples .............................................................................................. 129
2. Work Restrictions .................................................................................................. 130
Practices and Precautions .................................................................................... 130
3. Scabies ................................................................................................................. 130
Definitions ............................................................................................................. 130
Specific Interventions ............................................................................................ 131
Validation .............................................................................................................. 131
Laboratory Samples .............................................................................................. 131
Control Measures.................................................................................................. 131
Symptomatic Patients/Residents – Treatment ....................................................... 132
Asymptomatic Patients/Residents – Prophylaxis ................................................... 132
Symptomatic Staff – Treatment ............................................................................. 132
Environment .......................................................................................................... 132
Asymptomatic Staff, Volunteers and Physicians – Prophylaxis ............................. 133
Environmental Cleaning ........................................................................................ 133
Scabies Outbreak Conclusion ............................................................................... 133
PART 7: DEPARTMENTAL GUIDELINES ...................................................... 134
1. Inpatient Mother and Baby........................................................................................ 134
A.
Routine Practices ............................................................................................. 134
B.
Additional Precautions ...................................................................................... 134
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 9
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 21: Common Conditions and Precautions Needed ............................... 134
C.
Herpes .............................................................................................................. 135
Figure 10: Precautions Required When Caring for Mother with Non-Genital
Herpes ................................................................................................................... 135
Figure 11: Precautions Required When Caring for Mother with Genital
Herpes ................................................................................................................... 135
1. Staff Precautions................................................................................................... 135
D.
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms ......................................................................... 136
E.
Outbreaks ......................................................................................................... 136
2. Neonatal Intensive Care and Special Care Baby Units ............................................ 137
A.
Routine Practices ............................................................................................. 137
B.
Visitors .............................................................................................................. 137
C.
Additional Precautions ...................................................................................... 137
1. Contact Precautions .............................................................................................. 138
2. Droplet Precautions .............................................................................................. 138
3. Airborne Precautions............................................................................................. 138
Table 22: Common Conditions and Precautions Needed ............................... 139
D.
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms ......................................................................... 139
E.
Outbreaks ......................................................................................................... 140
3. Pediatrics .................................................................................................................. 140
A.
Routine Practices ............................................................................................. 140
B.
Additional Precautions ...................................................................................... 140
1. Contact Precautions .............................................................................................. 141
2. Droplet Precautions .............................................................................................. 141
3. Airborne Precautions............................................................................................. 142
C.
Communicability Periods .................................................................................. 142
D.
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms ......................................................................... 143
E.
Outbreaks ......................................................................................................... 143
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 10
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
4. Infection Prevention and Control Practices for Surgical Service Areas .................... 144
A.
Rationale .......................................................................................................... 144
B.
Principles .......................................................................................................... 144
Figure 12: Surgical Booking Procedure ........................................................... 146
Table 23: Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease
Transmission ........................................................................................................ 147
C.
Procedure Pre-Operatively ............................................................................... 148
1. Cases Without Identified Need for Additional Precautions ..................................... 148
2. Cases Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of Infection ........... 149
3. Cases Where Patient has Evidence of Infection: Contact or Droplet Precautions . 149
Figure 13: Surgical Housekeeping Algorithm .................................................. 151
D.
Procedure in the Operating Room .................................................................... 151
1. Routine Practices .................................................................................................. 151
2. Patient Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of Infection .......... 154
3. Cases with Infection – Contact and Droplet Precautions ....................................... 155
4. Cases with Infection – Airborne Precautions ......................................................... 156
E.
Procedure in the Post-Anaesthetic Area ........................................................... 156
1. Routine Practices .................................................................................................. 156
2. Patient Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of Infection .......... 157
3. Cases with Infection – Contact and Droplet Precautions ....................................... 157
4. Cases with Infection – Airborne Precautions ......................................................... 158
5. Burn Unit Recommendations .................................................................................... 159
Unit Isolation ......................................................................................................... 159
Patient Room ........................................................................................................ 159
Isolation Protocols................................................................................................. 160
Visitors .................................................................................................................. 160
Equipment and PPE .............................................................................................. 161
6. Renal Dialysis Department ....................................................................................... 161
A.
Introduction ....................................................................................................... 161
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 11
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
B.
Policy ................................................................................................................ 161
1. Guidelines for Patient Care ................................................................................... 161
Medication Administration ..................................................................................... 162
Environment and Supplies .................................................................................... 162
Patient Food and Snacks ...................................................................................... 162
Waste ................................................................................................................... 163
Equipment............................................................................................................. 163
Education .............................................................................................................. 163
2. Guidelines for Care of Vascular Access ................................................................ 163
Aseptic Procedure................................................................................................. 164
Skin Antisepsis – Fistulas, Grafts and Catheters ................................................... 164
Catheter Site Dressing Regime ............................................................................. 164
3. Surveillance .......................................................................................................... 165
ARO Screening for Renal Dialysis Patients/Residents .......................................... 165
Screening Requirements for Patients/Residents Not Known to be ARO Positive .. 165
Incoming Visiting Patients/Residents (Travelers) .................................................. 166
Outgoing Traveling Patients/Residents ................................................................. 166
Monitoring ARO Status for Patients/Residents Known to be MRSA or VRE Positive166
MRSA ................................................................................................................... 166
VRE ...................................................................................................................... 167
Consult with Infection Prevention and Control ....................................................... 167
4. Acute Care Patients Receiving Dialysis ................................................................ 167
5. Residential Care Residents Receiving Dialysis ..................................................... 167
6. Routine Surveillance, Evaluation and Management of Communicable Diseases .. 167
7. Guidelines for Patients/Residents Requiring Additional Precautions ..................... 168
Patient Placement for Dialysis ............................................................................... 168
Visitors .................................................................................................................. 168
8. Guidelines for Outbreak Management ................................................................... 168
9. Guidelines for Cleaning and Disinfection ............................................................... 169
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 12
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 24: Disinfection Procedures Recommended for Commonly Used
Items or Surfaces in Hemodialysis Units .......................................................... 169
Care and Maintenance of the Dialysis System ...................................................... 170
Water Treatment for Dialysis ................................................................................. 170
10. Guidelines for Peritoneal Dialysis .......................................................................... 170
7. Respiratory Department Guidelines .......................................................................... 173
A.
Introduction ....................................................................................................... 173
B.
Equipment ........................................................................................................ 173
C.
Disposable Equipment ...................................................................................... 173
D.
Respiratory Patients/Residents Requiring Additional Precautions .................... 173
1. Guidelines for Ventilator Associated Pneumonia (VAP) ........................................ 174
Definition ............................................................................................................... 174
VAP Prevention Strategies .................................................................................... 174
Surveillance .......................................................................................................... 174
Cross Contamination............................................................................................. 174
Airway Management ............................................................................................. 175
Gastric Reflux Prevention ..................................................................................... 175
Equipment............................................................................................................. 175
Oral Care .............................................................................................................. 175
PART 8: Specific Procedural Recommendations ............................................ 176
1. Asepsis ..................................................................................................................... 176
Microorganisms Live In and On Our Bodies .......................................................... 176
The Seven Keys of Asepsis .................................................................................. 176
Know what is clean ............................................................................................... 176
Know what is contaminated................................................................................... 177
Know what is sterile .............................................................................................. 177
Keep clean, contaminated and sterile items separated ......................................... 177
Keep sterile sites sterile ........................................................................................ 177
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 13
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Resolve contamination immediately ...................................................................... 177
Train yourself to realize when you have broken technique .................................... 177
Table 25: Approved Antiseptic Agents and Procedures ................................. 178
2. Environment and Furniture in Patient Care Areas .................................................... 180
A.
Furniture ........................................................................................................... 180
General ................................................................................................................. 180
Risk Levels ........................................................................................................... 180
Fabric .................................................................................................................... 180
Other Materials ..................................................................................................... 180
B.
Fixtures and Fittings ......................................................................................... 181
General ................................................................................................................. 181
Curtains and blinds ............................................................................................... 181
Fittings .................................................................................................................. 181
Vanity tops ............................................................................................................ 181
Handrails and Other Hardware .............................................................................. 182
Ceilings ................................................................................................................. 182
Walls ..................................................................................................................... 182
Floors .................................................................................................................... 182
Posted Signage and Other Posted Materials ......................................................... 182
APPENDICES ................................................................................................. 184
APPENDIX A: Type and Duration of Additional Precautions Where Recommended for
Selected Infections and Conditions ............................................................................... 184
APPENDIX B: Glossary of Terms .................................................................................. 208
APPENDIX C: Specific Cleaning Instructions ................................................................ 216
A.
Procedure for Cleaning Agitator Tubs/Hydrotherapy Tanks ............................. 216
B.
Procedure for Cleaning Fans ............................................................................ 216
C.
Procedure for Cleaning Commodes ................................................................. 217
D.
Procedure for Cleaning Suction Regulators...................................................... 217
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 14
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 1: INTRODUCTION
1.
Purpose
This manual has been prepared to assist the healthcare giver by providing a succinct and
current guide to infection prevention and control strategies in various healthcare settings.
The principles and guidelines set out in the Manual are based on national and international
published best practices, which have been modified to reflect the specific needs of VIHA. The
manual will be updated from time to time as best practices evolve, and the most current
edition will be posted on the VIHA website.
2.
Scope of the Document
This document covers VIHA Acute, Residential care, Home and Community Care and other
community settings. The implementation of routine practices applies to all programs and
departments.
3.
Guiding Principles
Infection prevention and control strategies are designed to protect patients/residents,
healthcare providers and the community.
Healthcare associated infections (HCAI) cause significant morbidity and mortality, and at least
30% are preventable by correctly following infection prevention and control principles (Haley
et al, 1984).
A systematic approach to infection prevention and control requires each healthcare provider
to play a vital role in protecting everyone who makes use of the healthcare system in all of its
may forms; pre-hospital settings, hospitals, clinics, offices, home care and community
programs.
Healthcare providers must follow infection prevention and control principles at all times, and
use critical thinking, risk assesment and problem solving in managing clinical situations.
Reference: Ontario Ministry of Health and Residential care Infection Prevention and Control Core Competencies
Program, 2005
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 15
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 2: UNDERSTANDING HOW INFECTIONS ARE
SPREAD
1.
The Chain of Infection
The spread of infection is best described as a chain with six links:
1.
a pathogen or causative (infectious) agent
2.
a reservoir
3.
a portal of exit from the reservoir
4.
a mode of transmission
5.
a portal of entry into the host
6.
a susceptible host
Figure 1: Chain of Infection
Infectious
Agents
Susceptible
Host
Reservoirs
Portal of
Entry
Portal of Exit
Mode of
Transmission
An infection can be prevented by breaking any link in the chain of infection. Infection
prevention and control measures are designed to break the links and thereby prevent new
infection. The chain of infection is the foundation of infection prevention and control.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 16
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
A.
Causative Agents
Bacteria, viruses, fungi and protozoa (microorganisms) are very common in the environment.
Most of these microorganisms cause people no harm, and can in fact be beneficial. Creating
an environment with no organisms is not a realistic goal.
Bacteria are single celled organisms, some of which can cause disease. We all live with
numerous bacteria, referred to as our ―normal flora‖ or ―resident bacteria‖, which usually do
not cause disease unless their balance is disturbed.
Most bacteria require an infectious dose to cause disease; that is, it usually takes thousands
to cause disease, not just one or two. Bacteria vary in infectivity (how easy they are to catch)
and virulence (the level of danger from the infection they cause).
Viruses are intracellular pathogens, either DNA or RNA, meaning they can only reproduce
inside a living cell. Viruses such as HIV and Hepatitis B and C have the ability to enter and
survive in the body for years before symptoms of disease occur. Other viruses, such as the
influenza viruses, quickly announce their presence through characteristic symptoms.
Fungi are prevalent throughout the world, but only a few cause diseases in humans, most of
which predominately affect the skin, nails and subcutaneous tissue. A common yeast,
Candida albicans, is normal human flora that can cause chronic or severe infections. Fungal
infections can be life threatening in critically ill patients/residents. Fungi such as
Pneumocystis carinii can be life threatening in persons with HIV/AIDS.
Prions are a form of infectious protein believed to be the cause of Creutzfeldt Jakob disease
(CJD).
Protozoa are single or multi-celled microorganisms that are larger than bacteria. Examples
of disease causing protozoa include Amoebas and Giardia, which cause diarrhea, and
Plasmodium species, the cause of malaria. They may be transmitted via direct or indirect
contact or the bite from an arthropod vector.
Parasites are larger organisms that can infect or infest people. Infestation with arthropods,
such as lice and scabies, occurs by direct contact with the arthropod or its eggs. Heminths
include roundworms, tapeworms and flukes. They infect humans principally through ingestion
of fertilized eggs or when the larvae penetrate the skin or mucous membranes.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 17
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Causative organisms can be eliminated by several methods, including:
Sterilizing surgical instruments and anything that comes into contact with sterile spaces
of the body
Using good food safety methods
Providing safe drinking water
Vaccinating people so they do not become reservoirs of illness
Treating people who are ill
Following good hand hygiene practices
B.
Reservoirs
Microorganisms require water to grow and reproduce, so reservoirs are often moist areas.
Sometimes a reservoir includes our own normal flora as a contaminant, such as at a sink
faucet.
In some cases the environment can serve as the reservoir. For example, water supplies may
become contaminated by Legionella species. Inadequate air exchange can allow pathogens
such as Mycobacterium tuberculosis and Aspergillus to contaminate air supplies.
Environmental contamination by pathogens such as Staphylococcus aureus and
Enterococcus species also commonly occur in bathrooms and/or on equipment. Appropriate
infection prevention and control measures and engineering controls can prevent these
reservoirs.
Common reservoirs in healthcare facilities include:
Ill people
Well people. Our normal flora includes bacteria that can be pathogenic if in the wrong
part of the body
Food; raw meat may harbor pathogens
Water from fish tanks or flower vases may contain pathogens, which can cause harm
especially for compromised patients/residents
Actions we take to eliminate reservoirs include:
Treating people who are ill
Vaccination
Safe handling and disposal of body fluids appropriately
Handling food safely
Monitoring for water contamination, and restricting flowers in sensitive areas of the
hospital
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 18
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 1: Human Reservoirs and Transmission of Infectious Agents
Reservoir
Transmission vehicle
Infectious agent
Blood
Blood, needle stick, other
contaminated equipment,
splashes
Hepatitis B and C
HIV
Staphylococcus aureus
Staphylococcus epidermidis
Skin and Soft Tissue
Drainage from a wound or
incision
Staphylococcus aureus
Coliforms
Pseudomonas
Reproductive tract and genitalia
Urine, semen, vaginal secretions
Neisseria gonorrhoeae
Treponema pallidum
Herpes simplex virus
Hepatitis B
Respiratory tract
Droplets from sneezing or
coughing
Influenza viruses
Group A streptococcus
Staphylococcus aureus
Tuberculosis
Gastrointestinal tract
Vomitus, feces, bile, saliva
Hepatitis A
Shigella
Salmonella
Norovirus
Rotavirus
Urinary tract
Urine
Escherichia coli
Enterococci
Pseudomonas
Note: This list is not exhaustive.
Reference: Public Health Agency of Canada. (1999) Routine Practices and Additional Precautions for
Preventing the Transmission of Infection in Health Care. (currently under revision)
C.
Portal of Exit
The portal of exit is the way in which the causative agent gets out of the reservoir, and it is the
link of the chain that we can do the least about. Any break in the skin, including natural
anatomical openings and draining lesions, may be the portal of exit from a person; any bodily
fluid may carry microorganisms out of the body. Some potent germs live on the
patient/resident‘s skin, and thus can easily exit their reservoir.
Actions we take to reduce risk from portals of exit include:
Covering coughs and sneezes with appropriate measures (e.g. coughing into the
elbow)
Handling body wearing appropriate personal protective equipment (gloves and gowns)
then performing correct hand hygiene
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 19
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Cover draining wounds covered with an appropriate dressing
Health care workers refraining from work when exudative (wet) lesions or weeping
dermatitis are present
D.
Transmission
This is the weakest link in the chain of infection. Most efforts to prevent the spread of
infection are aimed at eliminating the mode of transmission.
Microorganisms are transmitted in healthcare settings by several routes, and the same
microorganisms may be transmitted by more than one route. There are five main routes of
transmission; contact, droplet, airborne, common vehicle and vector borne. For the purpose
of this manual, common vehicle and vector borne will be discussed only briefly, as neither
play a significant role in HCAI.
1. Contact Transmission
Direct contact transmission is the most important and frequent mode of transmission of
HCAI, and is divided into direct and indirect contact transmission.
Indirect contact transmission usually involves contact between a susceptible host and a
contaminated inanimate object, such as equipment, instruments or environmental surfaces.
This is often the result of contaminated hands touching an object or environment. For
example, activity staff who use a ball to pass from resident to resident.
2. Droplet Transmission
Theoretically, droplet transmission is a form of contact transmission. However, the
mechanism of transfer of the pathogen to the host is quite distinct from either direct or indirect
contact transmission. Droplets are generated from the source person primarily during
coughing, sneezing and talking, and during the performance of certain procedures such as
suctioning and administering nebulized medications. Transmission occurs when large
droplets containing microorganisms generated from the infected person are propelled a short
distance through the air (usually less than one metre) and deposited on the host‘s
conjunctivae, nasal mucosa or mouth. Because droplets do not remain suspended in the air,
special air handling and ventilation are not required to prevent droplet transmission; that is,
droplet transmission must not be confused with airborne transmission. Droplets can also
contaminate the surrounding environment and lead to indirect contact transmission.
3. Airborne Transmission
Airborne transmission occurs by dissemination of either airborne droplet nuclei; small particle
residue (five microns or smaller in size) of evaporated droplets containing microorganisms or
dust particles containing the infectious agent (e.g. dust created by rotary powered foot care
tools). Microorganisms carried in this manner remain suspended in the air for long periods of
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 20
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
time and can be dispersed widely by air currents. These may be inhaled by a susceptible
host within the same room, or over a longer distance from the source patient/resident,
depending on environmental factors. Environmental controls are important – special air
handling and ventilation help reduce airborne transmission.
4. Common Vehicle Transmission
Common vehicle transmission applies to microorganisms transmitted by contaminated items
such as food, water and medications, to multiple hosts, and can cause explosive outbreaks.
Control is through using appropriate standards for handling food and water, preparing
medications and appropriate hand washing.
5. Vector Borne Transmission
Vector borne transmission occurs when vectors such as mosquitoes, flies, rats and other
vermin transmit microorganisms. This route of transmission is of less significance in
healthcare facilities in Canada than in other settings.
E.
Portal of Entry
The portal of entry can be thought of as the hole in the skin that allows the germ to get into
the body and cause disease. Pathogens cannot cause disease if they cannot get into the
body.
Examples of portals of entry include:
Mouth, nose and eyes
Other anatomical openings
Skin breaks (cuts, rashes)
Surgical wounds
Intravenous sites
Anatomical openings with tubes in place (these are more susceptible than those
without)
Needle puncture injuries
Actions to protect portals of entry include:
Dressings on surgical wounds
IV site dressings and care
Elimination of tubes as soon as possible
Masks, goggles and face shields
Keeping unwashed hands and objects away from the mouth (don‘t lick fingers to
turn pages)
Actions and devices to prevent needle stick injuries
Food and water safety
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 21
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
F.
Susceptible Host
Susceptibility can be reduced in several ways. For some diseases there are effective
vaccines. Some diseases produce lasting immunity after illness. People have better
resistance to disease when they are well rested, well fed and relatively stress free. People
who have a healthy immune system are often able to resist infection, even when bacteria are
present.
Host factors that influence the outcome of an exposure include the presence or absence of
natural barriers, the functional state of the immune system and the presence or absence of an
invasive devise.
Natural barriers to infection include:
Intact skin and mucous membranes
Cilia (small, hairlike projections that line the respiratory system) that filter inhaled air
and trap microorganisms
Lung macrophages – large white blood cells that ingest microorganisms, other cells
and foreign particles, in a process called phygocytosis
Antibodies (humeral immunity) resulting from immunization or previous disease
Acidic environment of the stomach, urine and vaginal secretions
Normal flora provides competition to pathogens. An upset to the balance of normal
flora can allow pathogens to cause infection, such as when a yeast infection follows a
course of antibiotics
The immune system is a complex network of cells, tissues and organs that interact to
defend the body against infections. Defense mechanisms can be non-specific or
specific and include humeral immunity (antibodies that circulate in the blood), cell
mediated immunity (white blood cells) and the inflammatory response, which brings an
increase in these infection fighting defenses to the site of infection
A person with normal immune system function is described as immunocompetent.
Someone whose immune system is impaired by illness or age is said to be
immunocompromised. The very young and the very old are at risk with a compromised
immune system. Infections are a major cause of death among newborns. Although babies
receive certain temporary immunities from their mother through the placenta and in breast
milk, their immune systems are still developing, making them vulnerable to infection.
Examples of susceptible hosts include:
People with chronic diseases
People with invasive devices or tubes in place (e.g. catheters)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 22
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Malnourished people
The very old and the very young
People who are tired or under high stress
People with skin breaks such as surgical wounds, IV sites or chronic rash
People undergoing steroid therapy or treatment for cancer
People with HIV Infection
People who are well and healthy. No one is immune to all disease
Actions required to minimize risk to susceptible hosts include:
Vaccinating people against illnesses to which they may be exposed
Preventing new exposure to infection in people who are already ill, are receiving
immunocompromising treatment or are infected with HIV
Maintaining good nutrition
Maintaining good skin condition
Covering skin breaks
Encouraging rest and balance
The nature of healthcare settings makes patients/residents vulnerable to the spread of
infections, because it brings together many ill people who are both reservoirs and susceptible
hosts. Staff are also both reservoirs and susceptible hosts, so we cannot eliminate those two
major links of the chain of infection. This is why we must make such efforts to eliminate the
mode of transmission; hand hygiene is still the single most effective way to prevent the
spread of infection.
The reservoir and the susceptible host may reside in the same person, if the individual‘s
normal flora gets into the ―wrong‖ part of the body it may cause infection. Examples of this
situation include:
Fecal flora in the urinary tract, causing a urinary tract infection (UTI)
Oral flora in the lungs, causing aspiration pneumonia
Skin flora in an IV site, causing a site infection or a blood stream infection
To avoid providing the mode of transmission between different body sites of the same
patient/resident, one must change gloves and wash hands when moving from one site to
another, from a contaminated area to a cleaner one following the ―Four Moments of Hand
Hygiene‖
Preventing the spread of infectious organisms includes:
Early identification of the infectious organism
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 23
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Prompt appropriate precautions put in place for patients/residents
Initiation of appropriate treatment
Precautions have disadvantages to the facility, patients/residents, personnel and visitors,
including the cost of specialized equipment and environmental controls, which inconvenience
healthcare workers and force solitude for patients/residents. However, these disadvantages
must be weighed against the facilities mission to prevent the spread of infection.
Source: Evans, N and McDonald, M. Infection Control Guidelines for Healthcare Professionals.
Routine Practices are to be applied at ALL times by ALL staff.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 24
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 3: INFECTION PREVENTION AND CONTROL
PRACTICES AND PRECAUTIONS
1.
ROUTINE PRACTICES
Infection prevention and control measures are designed to break the links in the Chain of
Infection and thereby prevent new infection. In healthcare settings, because agent and host
factors are more difficult to control, interruption in transfer of microorganisms is directed
primarily at transmission. Routine practices play a key role in preventing the transmission of
infectious disease.
The Public Health Agency of Canada (PHAC) has used the term ―Routine Practices‖ since
1999, for the process of risk assessment and risk reduction strategies. Routine practice,
previously known as Standard Precautions, is to be used with all patients/residents at all
times. Routine practices supersede, and are more encompassing than, previous Blood Borne
Pathogen Precautions or Universal Precautions.
Based on the assumption that all blood and certain body fluids (urine, feces, wound drainage,
sputum) contain infectious organisms (bacteria, viruses or fungi), routine practices reduce
exposure (both volume and frequency) of blood and body fluids to healthcare providers.
Furthermore, routine practices reduce the risk of cross infection through the reduction in
contamination and transmission of microorganisms.
The key to implementing routine practices is to assess the risk of transmission of
microorganisms before any interaction with patients/residents.
The elements of routine practices are summarized here into three parts:
a. Risk Assessment
b. Risk Reduction
c. Education
Modified from: The Canadian Committee on Antibiotic Resistance (2007) Infection Prevention and Control
Best Practices for Residential care, Home and Community Care including Health Care Offices and Ambulatory
Clinics.
A.
Risk Assessment
Risk assessment is performed principally to rule out the presence of infectious disease, but it
is also necessary to ensure that appropriate precautions are initiated for the various
procedures.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 25
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
1. Admission
Assessment should be standardized during the admission process to include:
Recent exposures to infectious diseases such as Chickenpox, Measles or Tuberculosis
Recent travel history, particularly travel abroad
New or worsening cough, and are unable to follow respiratory/cough etiquette
Fever
New undiagnosed rash
Sudden onset of diarrhea
Drainage or leakage not contained in a dressing and/or medical appliance
Any risk of colonization and/or infection with an Antibiotic Resistant Organism (ARO).
See the ARO Screening Questionnaire (catalogue number 28125) on the Forms
Navigation Bar.
2. Ongoing
A risk assessment should be completed on an ongoing basis, assessing the following:
Is the patient continent?
How susceptible is the patient to infection? Is their immune system intact?
Does the patient have any invasive devices or open areas?
What is the risk of exposure to blood, body fluids, microorganisms, mucous
membranes or non-intact skin in the task about to be performed?
Does the patient have a new or worsening cough, and are unable to follow
respiratory/cough etiquette?
Does the patient have a fever?
Does the patient have a new undiagnosed rash?
Does the patient have sudden onset of diarrhea?
Does the patient have any drainage or leakage not contained in a dressing and/or
medical appliance?
How competent is the healthcare provider in performing the task?
How cooperative will the patient be while the task is performed?
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 26
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 2: Risk Assessment Decision Tree - Acute Care
Healthcare Worker Approaches Patient
Routine Practices are initiated, including
assessment for infectious diseases.
The Risk Assessment for infectious diseases includes
assessing for:
 Fever/cough with or without a rash
 Skin/soft tissue infection
 Diarrhea illness Not Yet Diagnosed (with or without
vomiting)
NO
Infectious Disease
Suspected
YES
Continue Routine Practices
Continue Routine Practices
and add
Additional Precautions
Screen for MRSA and ensure
swabs are collected if indicated
Screen for MRSA and ensure
swabs are collected if indicated
Ongoing daily assessment
for infection
Assessment and diagnostic
investigations are conducted. Results
will aid in decision to continue or stop
Additional Precautions
If symptoms develop during
admission, go to "YES" stream.
STOP ADDITIONAL PRECAUTIONS
when criteria are met.
Perform daily assessments for new
infections.
This is not a static process. Assessment for infectious disease is ongoing and
adjustments to infection control precautions are applied based on new findings.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 27
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
B.
Risk Reduction
Risk reduction consists of many elements, all aimed at assisting the healthcare provider to
minimize his/her exposure to and contamination with microorganisms. The degree to which
the elements of risk reduction (e.g. personal protective equipment (PPE), clean environment)
are implemented are dependent upon the findings of the Risk Assessment. For example, the
choice of PPE and cleaning solutions will be determined by whether a patient presents with
undiagnosed diarrhea or not.
1. Hand hygiene
2. Respiratory/cough etiquette
3. Patient placement
4. Personal Protective Equipment
5. Uniform and work clothing
6. Safe handling of sharps
7. Decontamination
8. Housekeeping
9. Laundry
10. Waste
11. Managing dishes/tray delivery
12. Healthy workplace
1. Hand Hygiene
Hand hygiene is the single most important procedure for preventing cross infection. Body
secretions, excretions, environmental surfaces and hands of all healthcare workers can carry
microorganisms (bacteria, viruses and fungi) that are potentially infectious to them and others.
Hand washing is known to reduce patient morbidity and mortality from hospital acquired
infection. It causes a significant decrease in the carriage of potential pathogens on the
hands.
Indications for Hand Hygiene
The decision to decontaminate hands should be based on an assessment of the risk that
microorganisms have been acquired on the hands and transiently carried to another person
or location.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 28
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 3: The Four Moments of Hand Hygiene
Reference: Government of Ontario (2006)
Hand hygiene must be carried out in the following situations:
At the beginning of every shift
Before contact with any patient
In between contact with each and every patient
After contact with a patient on Additional Precautions or one who is colonized with
microorganisms of special clinical significance, e.g. resistant to a number of antibiotics
Before performing mouth care
Before and after contact with susceptible sites, e.g. wounds, burns, IV sites
Before performing invasive procedures, e.g. where natural defenses against infection
are breached
After hands have been contaminated, e.g. contact with body fluids, soiled linen,
equipment or garbage
After gloves have been removed
Before handling food or medicines
Before handling clean linen
After using the toilet or after toileting others
Before and after eating
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 29
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Prior to entering and leaving a nursing station
Prior to using computers and other electronic devices
Hand hygiene may also be desirable at other times. The Infection Prevention and Control
Team may request additional requirements for hand hygiene, e.g. during an outbreak of
infection.
Nail and Skin Care
The nails are the area of greatest contamination. Short nails are easier to clean and are less
likely to tear gloves. Please refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.1 – Hand Hygiene Policy.
Nail varnish is prohibited, regardless of colour, for staff with direct patient contact, or who
work in areas where direct patient contact takes place
Nail extensions/nail art and acrylic nails are prohibited for staff with direct patient contact,
or who work in areas where direct patient contact takes place
Ensure the skin on your hands does not become dry or damaged. In these conditions the
hands show a higher bacterial load, which is more difficult to remove than with healthy, intact
skin.
Hand lotion may be used to prevent skin damage from frequent hand washing.
Note: skin lotions for patient and/or staff use have been reported sources of outbreaks,
so pump dispensers are preferable over tubes or jars. If a pump dispenser is not
available, individualized containers must be used1
Creams that have been taken into a patient‘s room should be dedicated to that patient and
either disposed of or sent home with the patient on discharge
Compatibility between lotions and antiseptic products, and lotion‘s potential effect on glove
integrity should be checked (i.e. lotions should not be petroleum based). Please check
with Infection Prevention and Control or Occupational Health and Safety to ensure lotion is
approved for use
Type of Cleansing Agent
Alcohol Based Hand Rub
Indications:
Use routinely when hands are not physically soiled
1
Skin lotion and cream containers for patients are classified as single patient use items
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 30
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Alcohol based hand rubs2 (ABHR) can be used in place of soap and water, except where
hands are visibly soiled (e.g. feces, blood, etc.). They are especially useful in situations
where hand washing and drying facilities are inadequate or where there is a frequent need for
hands to be decontaminated (such as in client‘s homes). Every effort should be made to
install these products as close to point of care as possible.
Alcohol based surgical scrubs are used in situations where a reduction in the resident
microbial flora is considered desirable, such as in an operating theatre or similar department,
and before performing an invasive procedure, especially the placement of an indwelling
medical device.
Reference: WHO, World alliance for Patient Safety (2006) WHO guidelines on hand hygiene in healthcare
(advanced draft). April 2006. Report No: WHO/WPI/QPS/05.2
Soap and Water
Indications:
When hands are physically soiled
When hands look or feel dirty
Following contact with blood or body fluids
Following contact with any patient with diarrhea/vomiting, and their environment,
including bathroom facilities
In clinical areas, soap is supplied as liquid or foam, in sealed containers, where the
dispensing nozzle is integral to the container, and changed when the unit is empty. Soap
dispenser pumps are never to be reused, refilled or ―topped up‖ and must be disposed of
once empty.
It is recommended that hands are washed with soap and water if in contact with spores (e.g.
Clostridium difficile), because the physical action of washing, rinsing and drying hands has
been proven to be more effective than alcohols, chlorhexidine, iodophors and other antiseptic
agents.
Handwashing Technique
A brief wash will remove the majority of transient microorganisms, but the technique should
aim to cover all surfaces of the hands. Where soap or a surgical scrub has been used, hands
should be rinsed under running water and thoroughly dried with a disposable towel. The soap
and hand towels should be of a quality acceptable to users, so as not to deter hand washing.
The skin should be maintained in good condition to discourage the accumulation of bacteria.
2
The optimal concentration of ABHR is 70-90% with added emollients; a minimum of 70% ethanol will protect
against Norovirus. If the ABHR is a gel, a minimum of 80% ethanol is recommended. ABHR dispensers should
read volume per volume, not weight per volume.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 31
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Hand hygiene should include the cleaning of arms to the elbow, especially when wearing a
sleeveless apron.
Table 2: Levels of Hand Disinfection
Method
Social
Hygienic hand
disinfection
Aseptic (Surgical
scrub)
Solution
Alcohol based hand rub
or
Soap and Water hand wash (if visibly soiled
and/or contact with spores likely)
Soap and Water hand wash followed by an
alcohol based hand rub
A 2 minute antiseptic wash (i.e. chlorhexidine
(CHG 4%)) and dry on sterile towels
or
Soap and water hand wash followed by
surgical alcohol based hand rub
Task
For Routine Practices
Prior to invasive procedures performed at
unit level
Prior to surgical procedures
Hand Hygiene Procedure
The areas of the hands that are often missed are the wrist creases, thumbs, fingertips, under
the fingernails and under jewelry. For this reason, only a plain wedding band with no stones
is acceptable (please refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.1 – Hand Hygiene Policy).
Alcohol based hand rub technique
Soap and water hand wash must be performed if hands look or feel dirty
Apply an application to fill cupped palm of one hand
Rub into all surfaces of hands (finger tips and nails, wrists, palms, backs of hands and
between fingers)
There must be sufficient wetness on all skin surfaces that it takes 15 or more seconds to
dry
Rub hands together until rub has evaporated prior to gloving or touching the patient
Soap and Water hand washing technique
Wet your hands up to the wrists ensuring all surfaces of the hands are covered by water
Apply the cleanser/soap
Smooth it evenly all over your hands, including the thumbs and in between fingers, lather
well rubbing vigorously. Place fingertips and nails into the lathered palm and rub. Repeat
with opposite hand
Rinse off every trace of lather under running water, to prevent skin irritation
Dry thoroughly, taking special care between the fingers. More than one paper towel may
be necessary
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 32
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Surgical asepsis (scrub) technique with an alcohol based hand rub
Use sufficient product to keep hands and forearms wet with the alcohol based surgical scrub
(ABSS) throughout the procedure (usually at least a cupped hand filled with ABSS).
Apply ABSS to clean, dry hands and nails:
Cup hand and hold 1–2 inches from the nozzle
PUMP 1
o Dispense first full pump into the cupped palm of one hand (fill cupped hand)
o Dip fingertips of the opposite hand into the ABSS and work in under the nails
Wipe the excess solution from the fingertips back onto the palm of the same
hand
o Spread the remaining amount from the palm from wrist to elbow of the opposite
arm, covering all surfaces
PUMP 2
o Place another full pump into the opposite, dry palm and repeat the above
procedure with the other hand
PUMP 3
o Dispense a final full pump into either palm and reapply to all aspects of both
hands up to the wrist
o Proceed to the operating room suite holding hands above elbows
After applying ABSS allow hands and forearms to dry thoroughly before donning sterile
gloves and gown.
Surgical asepsis technique with a medicated soap
Wash hands and arms up to elbows with a non-medicated soap before entering the
Operating Room area or if hands are visibly soiled
Start timing
o Scrub each side of each finger, between the fingers and the back and front of the
hands for 2 minutes
o Scrub the arms, keeping the hand higher than the arm at all times. This helps to
avoid recontamination of the hands by water running from the elbows, and prevents
bacteria laden soap and water from contaminating the hands
o Wash each side of the arm from wrist to elbow for 1 minute
o Repeat this process on the other hand and arm, keeping the hands above the
elbows at all times. If the hand touches anything except the brush at any time, the
scrub must be lengthened by 1 minute for the area that has been contaminated
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 33
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
o Rinse hands and arms by passing them through the water in one direction only;
from fingertips to elbow
o Proceed to the operating room suite, holding hands above elbows
At all times during the scrub procedure, care should be taken not to splash water onto
surgical attire
Once in the operating room suite, hands and arms should be dried using a sterile towel
before putting on gown and gloves.
Aseptic technique must be maintained at all times
2. Respiratory Hygiene/Cough Etiquette
The transmission of SARS-CoV in emergency departments by patients and their family
members during the widespread SARS outbreaks in 2003 highlighted the need for vigilance
and prompt implementation of infection prevention and control measures at the first point of
encounter within a healthcare setting.
Respiratory hygiene/cough etiquette is targeted at patients/residents and accompanying
family members and friends with undiagnosed transmissible respiratory infections, and
applies to any person with signs of illness, including cough, congestion, rhinorrhea or
increased production of respiratory secretions when entering a healthcare facility.
The elements of respiratory hygiene/cough etiquette include:
Education of healthcare facility staff, patients/residents and visitors
Posted signs, in languages appropriate to the population being served, with
instructions to patients/residents and visitors
Source control measures (e.g. covering the mouth and nose with a tissue when
coughing and prompt disposal of used tissues, using surgical masks on the coughing
person when tolerated and appropriate)
Hand hygiene after contact with respiratory secretions
Spatial separation, ideally more than 6 feet between persons with respiratory infection
in common areas, when possible
It should be noted that although fever will be present in many respiratory infections,
patients/residents who are very old or very young and patients/residents with pertussis and
mild upper respiratory tract infections are often afebrile. Therefore, the absence of fever does
not always exclude respiratory infections.
Patients/residents who have asthma, allergic rhinitis or chronic obstructive lung disease also
may be coughing and sneezing. While these patients/residents often are not infectious,
cough etiquette measures are prudent.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 34
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Healthcare personnel are advised to observe droplet precautions and hand hygiene when
examining and caring for patients/residents with signs and symptoms of respiratory infection.
Healthcare personnel who have a respiratory infection are advised to avoid direct patient
contact, especially with high risk patients/residents. If this is not possible, then a mask should
be worn while providing patient care.
Modified from: Siegel, J.D., Rhinehart, E., Jackson, M. Chiarello, L. and the Healthcare Infection Control
Practices Advisory Committee (2007) Guideline for isolation precautions: preventing transmission of infectious
agents in healthcare settings. June 2007
3. Patient Placement
A further aspect of routine practices is the decision making process for patient placement.
Options include single patient rooms, two patient rooms and multi-bedded rooms/bays.
Single room accommodation is always the preferred option. However, most facilities have
limited resources in this area, and competing considerations when determining the
appropriate placement of patients/residents.
Single patient rooms are always preferred when there is a concern about the transmission of
an infectious agent. In situations that require prioritization of such accommodation, it is
prudent to prioritize these rooms for patients/residents who pose a high cross infection risk to
other patients/residents, particularly for those who are at increased risk of an adverse
outcome from the acquisition of an infection.
Occasionally, due to the number of patients/residents who are colonized or infected with the
same organism, cohorting the group of patients/residents in the same area may be an option
(see ARO Room Placement).
4. Personal Protective Equipment
Personal protective equipment (PPE) is used for two reasons:
To protect staff from blood or body fluid contamination
To reduce the risk of cross infection through the reduction in contamination and
transferring of microorganisms to other patients/residents, staff, visitors and the
environment
Gloves
The hands of clinical staff are the most likely means of transmission of healthcare associated
infection. Through hand washing and the appropriate use of gloves the risk of cross infection
is minimized.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 35
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
There are a number of materials used in the manufacture of gloves, including latex, nitrile and
vinyl (PVC). The choice of material will depend on the type of task being performed, contact
with chemicals and the risks associated with latex sensitization. The use of vinyl gloves is not
recommended for prolonged tasks that require manual dexterity or when contact with blood or
body fluids is anticipated.
The purpose of wearing gloves is to either prevent the hands becoming contaminated with dirt
or microorganisms, or to prevent the transfer of organisms already present on the skin or the
hands. It is essential to ensure that hands are washed before putting on gloves and following
the removal of gloves.
Table 3: Examples of Tasks that Require the Wearing of Gloves
Gloves must be worn:
When touching mucous membrane
When changing a dressing, or having contact
with non-intact skin
When changing diapers or adult briefs
When performing personal hygiene for clients
When performing mouth care
When indicated for Additional Precautions
Gloves should not be worn:
When there is no risk of exposure/ splash/
contact with blood, body fluids and non-intact
skin
When assisting or feeding a patient
For social touch
When pushing a wheelchair
When delivering meals, mail, clean linen
For providing care to clients with intact skin,
e.g. taking temperature
Staff must ensure that the appropriate type of glove is selected for particular procedures with
the purpose to ensure safety and protection for staff and patients/residents. When
considering the nature of the task, the need for sterile or non-sterile gloves should be
assessed.
Sterile gloves are worn to protect the patient during aseptic invasive procedures.
Non-sterile gloves, latex or latex alternative (e.g. nitrile) are worn to protect the healthcare
worker where direct exposure to blood or body fluids and other microorganisms is anticipated.
Storage of disposable gloves: it is important to store latex and nitrile gloves separately at
all times. This will include, and not be exclusive to, the clean utility room and within all clinical
area where the gloves are available for use. Although latex gloves are low protein, there is
still a risk of transfer of this protein to nitrile gloves.
Nitrile gloves are recommended as an alternative product to latex in the presence of allergy.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 36
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 4: Glove Use in Patient Care
Types
Specifications
Latex
Material
Level of
protection
Allergen content
Strength and
durability
Puncture
resistant
Fit and comfort
Chemical
resistance
Nitrile
Material
Level of
protection
Allergen content
Strength and
durability
Puncture
resistant
Fit and comfort
Chemical
resistance
Vinyl
(PVC)
Material
Level of
protection
Allergen content
Strength and
durability
Puncture
resistant
Fit and comfort
Chemical
resistance
Advantages
Disadvantages
Recommended use
Storage
Natural rubber
Long standing
barrier qualities
Powder free are
lower in allergens
Very strong and
durable
Has re-seal
qualities
Provides
excellent comfort
and fit
Good protection
from most
caustics and
detergents
Synthetic rubber
Excellent physical
properties and
dexterity
Contains no latex
protein
Very strong and
durable
Excellent
puncture
resistance
Good fit due to
high elasticity
Excellent
resistance
Poor against oils,
greases and
organics
Not
recommended
for individuals
who have
allergic reactions
or sensitivity to
latex
Most common
glove type for a
sterile glove and
for significant
exposures to
blood and blood
contaminated
body fluids
Recommended
for weak acids,
weak bases,
alcohols, water
solutions
DO NOT
STORE near
Nitrile gloves
Not
recommended
for aromatic
solvents, many
ketones, esters,
many
chlorinated
solvents
DO NOT
STORE near
Latex gloves
Polyvinyl chloride
Good level of
protection, but
based on the
quality of the
manufacturer
Punctures easily
when stressed
Rigid – non
elastic
Medium chemical
resistance
Not
recommended
for aliphatic,
aromatic and
chlorinated
solvents,
aldehydes,
keytones
Quality varies
with
manufacturers
Used as a
general purpose
glove when
additional
strength and
dexterity are
required
Recommended
for oils, greases,
acids, caustics,
aliphatic solvents
Alternative to
latex for those
with a latex
allergy for tasks
where exposure
to blood and
body fluids is
likely
Most common
type of general
purpose glove for
procedures of
short duration
and minimal
exposure to
blood and body
fluids
Recommended
for strong acids,
bases, salts,
other water
solutions, and
alcohols
Adapted from: Sunnybrook Hospital (Toronto) June 2008
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 37
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 4: Choosing the Correct Glove
Examination Glove
Latex /
latex alternative
(e.g. nitrile)
Vinyl (PVC)
Polyethylene/
Polythene
Only used in
catering
Sterile
Non-Sterile
Non-Sterile
 All aseptic
procedures with
potential
exposure to
blood or body
fluids.
 Sterile
pharmaceutical
preparations.
 Non-aseptic
procedures with
a high risk of
exposure to
blood or body
fluids.
 Procedures
involving sharps
 Handling
cytotoxic
material
 Handling
chemicals and
disinfectants
 Tasks which are
short and nonmanipulative
 Tasks which will
not pull or twist
the glove
 Tasks where
contact with
blood or body
fluids is unlikely
 For cleaning
tasks
Note: when handling chemicals and liquids, follow the manufacturer‘s guidelines on glove selection.
Non-disposable household gloves are worn for tasks other than direct patient care (e.g.
laundry, or for all work requiring chemicals, cleaners and disinfectants).
Where the use of non-disposable household gloves is required, the:
Employee‘s department will provide them
Department is responsible for maintaining written protocols on the use of gloves and
ensuring that employees are aware of and comply with these protocols
Gloves must meet WorkSafe BC standards for the task
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 38
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
o Non-disposable gloves must be designated to the individual worker, and must be
inspected by the worker daily to ensure that the gloves have no holes or tears in
them. If gloves are damaged, they must be discarded and replaced
o They must be dried and stored in a clean, dry area
o Disposable gloves must not be used as a liner
o If disposable gloves are used, then they must be changed regularly to ensure
integrity and cleanliness
o Regardless of type of glove, they must be washed between clean and dirty tasks
and whenever the floor bucket disinfectant solution is changed.
Gowns/Aprons
Disposable gowns and/or plastic aprons should be worn when there is a risk that clothing may
become exposed to blood, body fluids and excretions, with the exception of sweat, or when
close contact may lead to contamination by microbes from the patient, materials or
equipment.
Long sleeved impermeable gowns should be worn where there is a risk of contamination or
splashing of blood, body fluids, secretions or excretions, onto the skin or clothing of the
healthcare worker.
Gowns and aprons are worn as single use items, and must be disposed of after one
procedure or episode of patient care.
Hand hygiene following apron use must include cleaning of exposed arms to the elbows.
Scrubs or laboratory style coats/jackets worn over clothing are not considered to be PPE and
must not be worn in place of a disposable gown. Their long sleeves also inhibit correct hand
hygiene, and can be a source of contamination.
Cloth gowns do not provide the required protection and should not be used.
Gowns/aprons must be worn when the caregiver‘s clothing is likely to become
contaminated with blood, feces, urine or any other secretions
They must be worn when the uniform is likely to become contaminated by
microorganisms, e.g. during bed making
They must be worn when giving direct patient care
Gowns/aprons must only be worn for the duration of the task and disposed of as waste
Personal Protective Equipment should be changed following procedures, between
patients/residents, and if they become heavily contaminated or torn/split during a
procedure
Hand hygiene must be performed when the gown or apron is removed
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 39
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Hand hygiene must include cleaning of exposed arms to elbows if using an apron
Masks, Visors and Protective Eyewear
The mucous membranes of the mouth, nose and eyes are susceptible areas for infectious
agents. Therefore, the use of masks, visors or protective eyewear and full-face shields are
important parts of routine practices. Some masks are supplied with the additional protection
of a visor.
Masks with the additional protection of a visor are single use and must be disposed of when a
period of care has finished. Some visors are also supplied as single use, and as such must
not be decontaminated. However, reusable visors and goggles can be decontaminated using
a Hydrogen peroxide solution, or ready to use Hydrogen Peroxide 0.5% wipe.
Masks are worn:
By healthcare personnel when engaged in procedures requiring sterile technique to
protect patients/residents from exposure to infectious agents carried in the healthcare
worker‘s mouth or nose
By coughing/sneezing patients/residents to limit potential dissemination of infectious
respiratory secretions from the patient to others
By healthcare personnel when engaged in aerosol generating procedures with a patient
with a droplet infection, e.g. open suctioning, nebulized medication, bronchoscopy
A fit tested3 N95 mask is to be worn:
During the care of patients/residents who are diagnosed or suspected as having an
airborne infection (e.g. Pulmonary Tuberculosis)
N95 masks must be used during the entire period of infectiousness (consult with Infection
Prevention and Control)
A single-use N95 mask must only be worn once
Masks and eye protection or a visor are worn:
By healthcare personnel to protect them from contact with infectious material from
patients/residents, e.g. respiratory secretions and sprays of blood or body fluids,
consistent with Routine Practices and Droplet Precautions.
Please refer to Donning & Doffing PPE posters
3
Fit tests are performed by Employee Occupational Health & Safety.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 40
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
5. Hair/Jewelry/Uniforms
Hair
Hair should be clean, neat and tidy
Hair fastenings should be minimal
Long hair should be tied up off the collar when working in the clinical setting
Jewelry
Rings with stone settings must not be worn in clinical situations, as they compromise
hand hygiene. One plain wedding band is acceptable
Wrist watches, bracelets, bangles or other wrist adornments must be removed when
caring for patients/residents (exception: Medical Alert Bracelets) as they inhibit correct
hand hygiene. Please refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.1 - Hand Hygiene Policy for more
information
Footwear
Suede or fabric shoes are not acceptable as these cannot be shoe polished or
machine washed
Dress Code for Staff Who Do Not Wear a Uniform, Including Medical Staff
Long sleeves (i.e. scrubs, tee shirts or white coats with long sleeves) should not be
worn in the clinical setting and when assessing patients/residents due to the increased
potential of the cuffs coming into contact with patients/residents and becoming
contaminated4
Ties and lanyards (e.g. hanging nametags) should be tucked in prior to taking part in
clinical procedures
Dress Code for Staff Wearing a Uniform
Sleeves should end above the elbow. Long sleeves (white coats with long sleeves)
should not be worn in the clinical setting and when assessing patients/residents due to
the increased potential of the cuffs coming into contact with patients/residents and
becoming contaminated 5
4
If these requirements cannot be met for religious reasons, alternative options will be determined through
discussion with Infection Prevention and Control and area Manager.
5
If these requirements cannot be met for religious reasons, alternative options will be determined through
discussion with Infection Prevention and Control and area Manager.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 41
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Material should be such that it may be laundered on a HOT WASH (above 65
degrees C) to ensure adequate decontamination. A clean uniform must be worn every
shift/ working day
Sweaters or jackets should not be worn over the uniform, as they are likely to become
contaminated with microorganisms
Uniform should be changed as soon as possible after finishing work
Uniforms should not be worn when visiting public areas such as stores
References:
Department of Health 2007 UNIFORMS AND WORKWEAR An evidence base for developing local policy
Halls, F. et al 1984 ‗A question of uniform‘. NURSING TIMES Vol 87: No50, pp 53-54
6. Safe Handling of Sharps
The term ―sharps‖ includes items such as needles, scalpels, scissors, broken glass and other
items that may cause laceration or puncture to the skin.
Sharps are responsible for a significant number of injuries to staff each year. Safe
management of sharps can help to reduce the risk of injury, and therefore the acquisition of
infections such as blood borne viruses by both staff and patients/residents. A high proportion
of sharps injuries occur during disposal and waste collection.
Many sharps hazards have been removed through the introduction of safety engineered
sharps. Nonetheless, the prevention of sharps injuries is an essential part of routine
practices, including handling and disposing of sharps in a manner that will prevent injury to
the user and others. IV tubing should not be cut for disposal, as this will create a sharp end
and risk aerosolising the contents. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure the safe
disposal of a sharp.
Sharps disposal containers must be readily available in all areas
Sharps must be discarded immediately after use, directly into a disposal container at the
point of use
Sharps must not be recapped after use, prior to disposal directly into a disposal container
Never bend or break needles after use
Do not disassemble needles from syringes or other devices; always dispose of as a single
unit
IV tubing should be placed directly into a sharps disposal container without cutting it
Scalpel blades must be removed using forceps
Never fill a sharps disposal container more that ¾ full
Never leave a sharp protruding from the sharps disposal container
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 42
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
7. Decontamination
Transmission of infectious agents can occur during casual contact from inanimate object to
clean surfaces. Micro-organisms can survive on surfaces for long periods.
All items of reusable equipment and furnishing in healthcare settings must be cleaned and
disinfected/sterilized according to the manufacturer‘s instructions between patient use (e.g.
stretchers, BP cuffs, etc). Items that cannot be appropriately decontaminated must not be
purchased. Discuss possible new equipment with IPC Practitioner prior to purchasing it in
order to assess its suitability for the clinical area with regard to decontamination.
Cleaning
Definition: cleaning is the physical removal of dirt and organic matter. Cleaning removes up
to 80% of microorganisms and is an essential part of infection prevention and control.
Organic matter can inactivate certain disinfectants, and therefore must precede disinfection
and sterilization.
It is important to ensure that multi-use equipment is cleaned properly between
patients/residents. Equipment that is classified as critical or semi-critical must be
disinfected at the appropriate level following each use (See Disinfection Requirements for
Equipment).
Non-porous non-critical and other items, for example scales or stethoscopes, can be easily
cleaned with an intermediate or low-level disinfectant (see Reprocessing Decision Chart
Table below and Classes of Organisms in Order of Susceptibility).
Non-critical and other items made of fabric material should be cleaned when visibly soiled and
following exposure to blood or body fluids. These items should also have an established
routine cleaning with an intermediate or low-level disinfectant. Items such as blood pressure
cuffs, which come into contact with the patient, should be wiped between patients/residents
using a disinfectant wipe.
Patients/residents on additional precautions require dedicated equipment wherever possible.
If this is not possible, all equipment must be thoroughly decontaminated following each use,
regardless of its classification.
If equipment/device cannot be immediately disinfected, all soil must be immediately removed
from the device.
Table 5: Reprocessing Decision Chart
Process
Cleaning
Some items
may require
Item
All reusable
equipment
Examples
All equipment requires cleaning after
use and before further disinfection
processes are initiated
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Products and methods
Physical removal of soil, dust, or
foreign material. Chemical, thermal,
or mechanical aids may be used.
Page 43
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Process
low level
disinfection
Cleaning
followed by
intermediate
level
disinfection
Item
Examples
Specific environmental surfaces that
are touched by personnel during
procedures involving parenteral or
mucous membrane contact (e.g.
dental lamps)
Bedpans, urinals, commodes
Stethoscopes
Blood pressure cuffs
Ear specula
Hemodialysis surfaces in contact
with dialysate
Products and methods
Soap and water
Enzymatic agents
Quaternary ammonium
compounds
Some iodophors (e.g. 3%
hydrogen peroxide)
Some
Semi-critical
items
After large environmental blood spills
Alcohols
or spills of microbial cultures in the
Hypochlorite solutions
laboratory
Iodophors
Glass or electronic thermometers
Hydrotherapy tanks for
patients/residents whose skin is
not intact
Cleaning
Semi-critical
Items intended for sterilization in the
Flexible endoscopes,
followed by
items
plasma or EO sterilizers must be
laryngoscopes, respiratory
high level
meticulously cleaned prior to
therapy equipment
disinfection
sterilizing.
Nebulizer cups
Anaesthesia equipment
Pasteurization
Nasal specula
2% gluteraldehyde
Tonometer food plate
6% hydrogen peroxide
Ear syringe nozzles
Peracetic acid
Vaginal specula
Chlorine or chlorine compounds
Vaginal probes used in
sonographic scanning
Pessary and diaphragm fitting
rings
Cervical caps
Breast pump accessories
Cleaning
Critical items
All items coming into contact with Glass or electronic thermometers
followed by
Steam under pressure
sterile tissue
sterilization
Dry heat
Surgical instruments
All instruments used for foot care Ethylene oxide gas
2% glutaraldehyde
All implantable devices
6-25% hydrogen peroxide
Cardiac and urinary catheters
peracetic acid
All intravascular devices
chlorine dioxide
Biopsy forceps or biopsy
6-8% formaldehyde
equipment associated with
endoscopy equipment
Bronchoscopes, arthroscopes,
laparoscopes
Cystoscopes
Transfer forceps
High speed dental hand pieces
Adapted from: Health Canada, CCDR Hand Washing, Cleaning, Disinfection and Sterilization in Health Care,
December 1998, Volume 24S8
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 44
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Disinfection
Definition: Removal and destruction of most pathogens (or disease-causing organisms) by
the use of friction (cleaning) and a use of a disinfectant.
Usually disinfectants are ―cidal‖ in that they kill the susceptible potential pathogenic agents.
Generally, disinfectants used throughout VIHA both clean and disinfect. The selection of a
disinfectant should be based on the function the disinfectant is expected to perform, not
necessarily on a sales pitch or on what has always been used. Ideally, a disinfectant should
be broad spectrum (eliminates bacteria, viruses, protozoa, fungi and spores). The Table on
Classes of Organisms in Order of Susceptibility to Disinfectant – outlines the classes of
organisms and what is required in the way of disinfectants to eliminate them.
Disinfectants are necessary in healthcare settings to kill potentially infectious microorganisms,
but may be harmful to staff/patients/residents/public if used inappropriately.
All disinfectants used in VIHA facilities are to be approved for use in healthcare
facilities and possess a drug identification number from the Health Protection Branch of
Health Canada
Disinfectants should be compatible with the equipment/device to be disinfected
The use of the device should be considered when deciding the type of disinfectant to
use
Personal and environmental safety should also be considered when selecting a
disinfectant
The manufacturer‘s instructions for use and storage must be followed
Disinfectants should also be:
Non-irritating
Non-toxic
Non-corrosive
Inexpensive
Selection decisions should include effectiveness against the potential pathogenic agent,
safety to people, impact on equipment, the environment, and expense.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 45
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 6: Classes of Organisms in Order of Susceptibility to Disinfectants
Organism Type
Hardiest
Organisms
Bacteria with Spores
(B. subtitles, C. tetani, C. difficile, C. botulinum,
B. anthracis)
Level of Disinfectant
Chemical Sterilant
Protozoa with Cysts
Giardia lablia, Cryptosporidium parvum)
Mycobacteria
(M. tuberculosis, M. avium-intracellulare,
M. abscessus)
Non-Enveloped Viruses
(Coxsackievirus, poliovirus, rhinovirus, Norwalk-like
Virus, hepatitis A virus)
Fungi
Candida species, Cryptococcus species, Aspergillus
species, Dermatophytes)
High Level
Intermediate Level
Vegetative Bacteria
(Staphylococcus aureus, Salmonella typhi,
Pseudomonas aeruginosa, coliforms)
Most
Susceptible
Organisms
Enveloped Viruses (Herpes simplex, varicella-zoster
virus, cytomegalovirus, measles virus, mumps virus,
rubella virus, influenza A and B virus, respiratory
syncytial virus, hepatitis B & C viruses, hantavirus
and human immunodeficiency virus)
Low Level
The effectiveness of a disinfectant depends on many factors. These include:
Type of contaminating microorganism. Each disinfectant has unique antimicrobial
attributes
Degree of contamination. This determines the quality, efficacy and time of exposure of
the disinfectant required
Amount of protein based material present. High protein based materials absorb and
neutralize some chemical disinfectants
Presence of organic matter and other compounds such as soaps may neutralize
disinfectants
Chemical nature of disinfectant. It is important to understand the mode of action in
order to select the appropriate disinfectant
Concentration and quantity of disinfectant. It is important to choose the proper
concentration and quantity of disinfectant that is best suited to each situation
Contact time and temperature. Sufficient time and appropriate temperature must be
allowed for action of the disinfectant and may depend on the degree of contamination
and organic matter load
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 46
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Residual activity and effects on fabric and metal should be considered for specific
situations
Application temperature, pH and interactions with other compounds must be
considered
Source: BCCDC Laboratory Services, A Guide to Selection and Use of Disinfectants, 2003
Table 7: Disinfection Requirements for Equipment
Category
Critical
Items that come in
contact with the blood
stream or sterile body
tissues
Semi Critical
Items that come in
contact with mucous
membranes or non-intact
skin
Non-Critical
Items that come in
contact with intact skin
Items that do not come in
contact with the patient‘s
skin
Level of Disinfection
Sterilization
Examples
Surgical instruments
Acupuncture needles
Foot care instruments
High Level Disinfection
Internal scopes
High Level Disinfection
Intermediate Level
Disinfection
Intermediate Level
Disinfection
Low Level Disinfection
Contact lenses
Reusable Peek Flow Meters
Mouthpieces
Thermometers
Ear syringe nozzles
Examination tables
Stethoscope
Blood pressure cuff
Skin probes
Furnishings
Dishes
Scales
The advantages and disadvantages of the various chemical disinfectants are highlighted
below.
Table 8: Advantages and Disadvantages of Major Chemical Disinfectants
Disinfectant
Level of
Uses
Advantages
Disadvantages
Disinfection
Manufacturers‘ Recommendations for Concentration and Exposure Time must always be followed
Alcohols
IntermeExternal surfaces · Fast acting
· Flammable – keep away from
(70% Isopropyl –
diate
of patient
· No residue
sources of ignition
undiluted)
assessment
· Non staining
· Dilution with water will diminish
equipment, e.g.
concentration and efficacy
O2 saturation
· Inactivated by organic material
monitors, finger
· May harden rubber or cause
clips,
deterioration of glues
thermometers,
· Use in the OR near cautery is
stethoscopes
discouraged; can be on
anesthetic carts or wall mounts
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 47
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Disinfectant
Level of
Uses
Advantages
Disadvantages
Disinfection
Manufacturers‘ Recommendations for Concentration and Exposure Time must always be followed
6
Chlorines
IntermeDisinfect
· Low cost
· Corrosive to metals
Household bleach diate
hydrotherapy
· Fast acting
· Inactivated by organic material,
(5% Sodium
tanks, dialysis
· Readily
e.g. blood, feces
Hypochlorite)
equipment,
available in non· Irritant to skin and mucous
mixed at a ratio of
cardiopulmonary
hospital settings
membranes
1 part bleach to 9
training
· Have sporicidal
· Use in well-ventilated areas
parts water, for a
manikins,
properties
· Unstable when diluted and
total of 10 parts)
environmental
exposed to light (must be kept in
surfaces, and
an opaque container)
glucometers.
· For effective use, the following
must be considered:
Effective
Appropriate dilution;
disinfectant
Stability/shelf life prior to
following blood
dilution;
spills.
Stability/shelf life of product
after dilution
· Follow manufacturer‘s
instructions for duration of shelf
life, both before and after
reconstitution
· Tablets and mixed solutions
remain stable < 24 hours after
reconstitution
· Bottles of bleach normally remain
stable < 30 days after opening if
in an opaque container.
Household
bleach
(5% Sodium
Hypochlorite)
mixed at a ratio of
1 part bleach to
499 parts water,
for a total of 500
parts)
(1 cup per
laundry tub)
(100 ppm)
6
For cleaning of
personal laundry
Also available in tablet and granule form. Follow manufacturer‘s instructions for proper dilution.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 48
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Disinfectant
Level of
Uses
Advantages
Disadvantages
Disinfection
Manufacturers‘ Recommendations for Concentration and Exposure Time must always be followed
Hydrogen
Low
Equipment used
· Available to use
· Can be corrosive to aluminum,
peroxide
for home
in ready-to-use
copper, brass or zinc
3% concentrate
healthcare,
wipes
· Cannot be used on anesthetic
diluted at a ratio
patient
· Strong oxidant
hosing
of 1 part
assessment and
with good
· Limited sporicidal activity
Hydrogen
care at the
cleaning
· Wet contact time must be more
Peroxide to 16
bedside and
properties
than 5 minutes
parts water for
other treatment
· Fast acting
patient care
settings.
· Bactericidal in
surfaces.
less than 1
minute
· Viricidal in less
than 5 minutes
· Environmentally
friendly
Hydrogen
peroxide
3% concentrate
diluted at a ratio
of 1 part
Hydrogen
Peroxide to 64
parts water for
floors
Quaternary
ammonium
compounds
(Usually diluted at
1 part quaternary
ammonia to 256
parts water)
Cleans floors,
walls and
furnishings.
Low
Routinely used in
facilities for
environmental
cleaning in
patient care
areas (e.g.
floors, walls and
furnishings).
· Inexpensive
· Generally nonirritating to
hands in diluted
form
· Contain
cleaning
properties
· Mildly corrosive
· Limited use as disinfectant
because narrow microbiocidal
spectrum
· Non-sporicidal
Modified from: Health Canada. Canadian Communicable Disease Report, Dec 1998, Vol. 24S.
Sterilization
The highest level of asepsis is defined by the removal of all microorganisms. It is achieved by
autoclaving or by another sterilization process. Items must be thoroughly cleaned before
sterilization can occur. For information on sterilization techniques used in your facility contact
your local Central Sterilizing/Processing department. (Reprocessing Policy Manual)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 49
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Storage
Storage of Contaminated Equipment
Storage of contaminated equipment is to be held in a designated area/container
Gross soil must be removed before storage prior to cleaning
The storage area must be physically separated (by walls where possible) from a clean
area, and be cleaned daily
Hand hygiene must be performed before leaving the ―dirty‖ area
Once items are cleaned, they should be labeled as such, and moved to a clean
storage area
Storage of Clean/Sterilized Equipment
Areas designated for clean equipment should have a sign displayed identifying the
area, and/or cleaned equipment should be labeled as clean
Shelf life is event related, not always time related. Sterilized equipment/devices are no
longer considered sterile if there is a disruption in the integrity of the packaging (e.g.
packaging tear, the packaging becomes wet, or the item is dropped)
Items purchased as sterile must be used before the expiration date. If the expiration
date has passed, the item must be discarded
The areas in which medical devices are stored or handled should be used for storage
only, protected from vermin, moisture and the entry of dust from adjacent areas and
ventilation systems. There must be sufficient storage space to prevent damage to the
packages
Sterile items should be stored in an area with limited traffic and a door
Sterile medical devices should be stored at least:
25 cm from the floor
45 cm from the ceiling
5 cm from the wall
Cardboard boxes must not be used for storage
All storage should be above floor level to allow appropriate cleaning
Storage must be away from a sink area, to prevent contamination from splashing
Event Related Sterility
Devices that are received sterile must be maintained sterile until used or until the
expiration date has passed, and they are discarded
Shelf life of sterile items is event related. Event related factors that may cause
contamination and decrease shelf life are:
Method and frequency of handling (e.g. dropping a sterile item on the floor renders
it contaminated)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 50
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Method and conditions of storage, such as location (e.g. shelves located below
knee level are considered at risk for contamination and are not appropriate for
storage of sterile items)
Space (e.g. sterile items stored beside a sink are at risk for splashing with water
which compromises the integrity of packaging)
Temperature, humidity and exposure to moisture, dirt, dust or vermin
All sterile items must be checked for sterility before use. The date of expiration relates
to product ingredients and stability. For packaged items, check to ensure the integrity
of the package is intact and the sterile indicator is white with black stripes
All cleaned and disinfected/sterilized devices must be covered and protected from
moisture and dust during transport
8. Housekeeping
The environment acts as a suitable reservoir for many microorganisms, and therefore the
provision of a clean environment for patient care is an integral part of infection prevention and
control. (Housekeeping Section)
9. Laundry
All laundry is treated the same regardless whether a patient is on routine or additional
precautions. Soiled linen shall be handled and transported in a manner in which
contaminants are confined and contained. Clean linen that has been dropped on the floor is
considered soiled.
Soiled Linen
Using the guidelines of routine practices, soiled or used linens generated from all sources are
considered to be contaminated.
Soiled linen from all patients/residents or areas will be handled in the same manner:
Wear non-sterile gloves and disposable gown or apron
Position hamper/tote/laundry bag in room (i.e. locate centrally in room and open lid) or
as close to the room entrance as possible
Ensure that linen is free of biomedical waste, sharps, instruments, and patient‘s
personal belongings
Roll linen carefully into itself. Avoid shaking or fluffing
Dispose of into linen tote/hamper
Remove PPE and perform appropriate hand hygiene
Dirty linen is not to be placed on the bedside tables, floor or in the sink
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 51
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Soiled linen is to be handled as little as possible:
Following removal from the patient bed space, linen must be immediately placed into a
hamper/tote/laundry bag
To prevent staff injuries, the soiled linen hamper/tote/laundry bags should not be
overfilled. Close when ⅔ full
Linen that is heavily soiled, saturated or dripping should be placed in a leak proof clear
plastic bag and then placed inside the regular hamper/ tote/ laundry bag
The laundry hamper/tote/bags, particularly the large laundry bins should be stored in a
predetermined dirty area that is at least one meter from any clean items and at least
one meter from any fire equipment
Mattresses and pillows that are covered with impervious plastic do not have to be sent to the
Regional Laundry for cleaning and disinfecting as they can be effectively cleaned on-site
using an appropriate disinfectant (see the Reprocessing Decision Chart). Mattresses and
pillows must also be monitored for wear points, and replaced as necessary.
Remove PPE after handling soiled linen and
perform hand hygiene before handling clean linen
Laundering on the Units
Laundering on units is not advocated in acute care setting. However, in some areas such as
residential care settings it may be necessary. In these cases, the following is recommended:
The outside of the machines (i.e. washer and dryer) should be cleaned with
disinfectant prior to each use
If hot-water laundry cycles are used, wash with detergent in water of at least 71o C (at
least 160o F) for a cycle of 25 minutes or more
Once washed, items should be dried quickly in a dryer (i.e. not air dried)
The laundry area should be in a dedicated space and must not be located in the same
area as a dishwasher or fridge (used for food)
Clean Linen
Soiled linen must never come into contact with clean linen.
Perform hand hygiene prior to removing clean linen
from central supply area or from carts.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 52
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Clean linen should be unpacked on return from the laundry and stored in a designated
area within each department
The linen room should have a door, which should be kept closed. If this is not possible
then the linen cart covers should remain closed around the linen racks when not being
accessed
Clean linen must be stored at least one meter away from any ―dirty area/items‖ or fire
equipment
Clean linen must be stored at least one meter from any dirty items
Clean linen is to be handled as little as possible
Linen which is removed from the clean supply area/cart is not to be returned to that
cart
The clean supply cart should only be stocked with one day‘s supply, which should be
used before restocking the cart
Linen carts are to be dedicated for linen only. The clean linen carts are not to contain
other supplies
Staff involved in the handling of linen shall ensure that there is no cross contamination of
clean and soiled linens during transportation and storage.
Handling Soiled Linen contaminated with Hazardous Materials
When hazardous materials are used, stored or disposed of, written safe work procedures
must be developed and implemented for preparation, administration and waste handling.
Departments intending to return soiled linens that are contaminated with hazardous materials
must ensure that there is no potential risk to staff or patients/residents.
Hazardous materials include, but are not limited to:
Chemicals that are a risk due to being toxic, poisonous, carcinogenic, noxious,
flammable, combustible, corrosive or reactive with other chemicals.
Radioactive substances that are present on soiled linen will be decontaminated at the
site at which the patient resides. Linen contaminated by radioactive substances will
not be sent to the Laundry until it is decontaminated by removing the radioactive
nuclide contaminants or setting it aside for the appropriate time (i.e. ten half lives).
Chemotherapy drugs (i.e. Antineoplastics).
Any contaminated linen identified by the user site as not able to be safely laundered will be
disposed of by the original hospital. For replacement purposes, the originating hospital will
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 53
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
inform the Regional Laundry of the disposal of its linen. If disposal of linen products
contaminated by hazardous material is inevitable, the user hospital will consider the use of
either disposable products or specific ―discard linen‖ which are linens that are usable but near
the end of their life cycle.
Note: Items of linen from patients/residents with unusual infections (e.g. Anthrax, Lassa Fever) should not be
disposed of without consulting either the Medical Microbiologist in the first instance or the Infection Control
Practitioner.
Reference: Fraser Health Authority, Acute Care Infection Prevention and Control Manual, 2008
10. Waste
VIHA is committed to the safety of the general public, patients/residents and staff. This is of
the utmost importance and, therefore, procedures will be adopted whereby any risks
associated with waste disposal will be minimized. The object of this section is to provide
guidelines and give procedures for the safe disposal of hospital waste.
All garbage must be placed in leak proof bags and closed securely before removal from
patient‘s room. When garbage bags are ⅔ full it should be secured and removed.
All housekeeping staff will wear personal protective clothing when handling clinical waste.
This clothing in normal circumstances will take the form of their general uniform, disposable
apron and protective gloves. All staff who need to move bags of waste by hand should:
Ensure the bags are effectively sealed and are intact
Handle bags by the neck only
Know the procedure in case of accidental spillage
Waste items such as used bandages, briefs and garbage are
not to be placed on the bedside tables, floor or in the sink
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 54
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Yellow Bag
Clinical / Biohazardous
Waste
Black Bag
Domestic/ General
Waste
Containers of blood or other blood saturated body fluids.
Disposable containers which are not emptied prior to
disposal, should be securely taped shut and tubing clamped
Secretions or exudates whose contents cannot be
hygienically emptied into toilet (e.g. Hemovac, sputum vial)
Transfusion lines or bags containing blood
All body tissue – including ‗Exempt body tissue‘ derived from
the operating room
Items saturated and dripping with blood and body fluids
Microbiology cultures
Waste derived from the clinical and non clinical areas which
is not mentioned above and is not heavily contaminated with
blood or body fluids
Urinary drainage bags and catheters
Feces
Office waste
Kitchen waste
For chemotherapy disposal, see appropriate reference.
Biohazardous Waste
Biohazardous waste bags should only be filled to ⅔ full, as overfilling will prevent bags
from being tied securely
The containers for removal of biohazardous waste should be easily recognized, leak
proof, and have a durable fitted lid. They must be sealed prior to transport and stored
in areas unavailable to untrained staff, patients/residents or the public.
Gloves and disposable apron should be worn when handling biohazardous waste.
Hands should be decontaminated appropriately following removal of gloves
Goggles or face shields should be worn when disposing of body fluids if there is a
possibility of splash exposure to eyes or mucous membranes.
NOTE: Final disposal of Biohazardous waste will be either by incineration or by autoclaving followed by landfill
disposal.
Spillage of Blood or Body Fluids
(Body Fluids, Secretions and Excretions)
Wear gloves and disposable apron
Gross soil must be removed prior to cleaning and disinfecting
Use paper towels for small spills, mop for large spills
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 55
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Clean the area
Disinfect with approved hospital disinfectant or a fresh solution of household bleach
(one part 5% bleach added to 9 parts water). Used paper towels, gloves and apron
should be placed in Biohazardous Waste bag
Mop heads should be placed in leak proof laundry bags
Bucket contents should be poured down the hopper, and the bucket rinsed and wiped
with the chlorine solution
Hands must be washed at the end of the procedure
Waste Containers
Only impervious waste containers dedicated for the transporting of clinical waste should be
used to minimize the potential for spillage and subsequent contamination of work place areas.
Garbage bins used in all non-office environments should all have lids that ideally open with a
foot-operated mechanism.
Waste trolleys must be such that they can be easily cleaned and drained, do not offer
harbourage to insects, and particles of waste do not become lodged in their fabric. The waste
must be easily loaded, secured and unloaded. Clinical waste must not be transported in any
other type of trolley. Biohazardous waste, sharps and general waste must never be mixed.
11. Managing Dishes, Glasses, Cups and Eating Utensils
Dishes/utensils are managed in the same manner, regardless whether a patient is on routine
or additional precautions.
Food Service workers must wash hands before leaving the kitchen and upon returning
to the kitchen, after both delivery and pick-up of trolleys
Food Service workers must decontaminate hands using an ABHR or wash hands
upon entry and exit of each unit and as needed before handling the next tray in the
event the patient‘s personal effects were touched to allow placement of the tray on the
over bed table. Gloves are not required in the delivery of trays
For removal of trays, Food Service Workers must decontaminate hands upon entry to
each unit and before putting on gloves. Trays are picked up from the over bed tables
and returned to the trolley. Gloves are removed upon completion of tray pick-up,
discarded appropriately, and hands decontaminated before leaving the unit. Carts
must be covered prior to leaving the unit
All trays and wares are washed, rinsed and sanitized in the kitchen area in accordance
with standard dishwashing procedures
Trolleys are washed, rinsed and sanitized by Food Services personnel between each
meal period, and allowed to air dry before reuse
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 56
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Trolleys left on the unit for late trays are to be washed, rinsed and sanitized when
taken to the food services area, and at a minimum on a weekly basis
Note: Food Service Workers will not pick up any trays that contain bodily fluids or sharps.
They will bring this to the attention of the nursing staff.
Routine Practices
Tray Delivery
Tray Pick-up
Wash hands prior to tray delivery.
Disposable gloves not required.
Wear disposable gloves.
Unit Staff
Over bed table must be free of
equipment and debris.
No preparations required.
Food Service Worker
Food Service worker does not clear
over bed table. Place the tray on
the over bed table following
standard tray delivery procedures.
With gloved hands, pick-up the tray
and return it to the tray cart. Gloves
are removed upon completion of tray
pick-up, discarded, and hands
washed or alcohol based hand rub
applied before leaving the unit.
Managing Tray Delivery – Procedures Specific to Additional Precautions
The automated decontamination washing process effectively deals with all microorganisms.
Disposable dishes and utensils will not be used. Food Services personnel wear
aprons and gloves to strip all trays as all patient trays are considered contaminated
Food trays must never be bagged. On the rare occasion that a patient vomits onto the
tray, nursing staff (using droplet precautions) rinse off the vomit prior to returning the
tray to the kitchen for disinfection
Note: Food Service Workers will not pick up any trays that contain bodily fluids or sharps.
They will bring this to the attention of the nursing staff.
Contact Precautions
(Yellow Sign)
Unit Staff
Food Service Worker
Tray Delivery
Wash hands prior to tray delivery.
Disposable gloves not required
Over bed table must be free of
equipment and debris.
Food Service worker does not clear
over bed table. Place the tray on the
over bed table following standard
tray delivery procedures.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Tray Pick-up
Wear disposable gloves
No preparations required.
With gloved hands, pick-up the tray
and return it to the tray cart. Remove
gloves, wash hands or use ABHR
and put on clean gloves prior to
collecting any other trays.
Page 57
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Contact Precautions
(Yellow Sign)
AND SIGN FOR
2 STEP CLEANING
Unit Staff
Food Service Worker
Droplet Precautions
(Green Sign)
Unit Staff
Food Service Worker
Tray Delivery
Tray Pick-up
Wash hands prior to tray delivery.
Wear disposable gloves
Disposable gloves not required
Note: Food Service Personnel will not deliver/collect trays for anyone
with gastro-intestinal symptoms.
Over bed table must be free of
equipment and debris. Tray is taken
directly from the trolley and delivered
by nursing staff to patients/residents
with gastro-intestinal symptoms.
Nursing staff return the tray to the
trolley for anyone with gastrointestinal symptoms. Ensure the
trolley is left uncovered.
Trolley is brought to the unit. Trays
for patients/residents with gastrointestinal illness (designated by 2
step cleaning sign) are left on the
trolley and unit staff are notified.
Trays are delivered to
patients/residents on routine
practices or contact precautions.
Trays are not removed from patient
rooms for anyone with gastrointestinal illness. With gloved hands,
collect trays from patients/residents‘
on routine practices or contact
precautions. Gloves are removed
upon completion of tray pick-up,
discarded, and hands washed or
ABHR applied before leaving the
unit.
Tray Delivery
Tray Pick-up
Wash hands prior to tray delivery.
Disposable gloves not required
Over bed table must be free of
debris. Tray is taken directly from
the trolley and delivered by nursing
staff to patients/residents on droplet
precautions.
Wear disposable gloves
Trolley is brought to the unit. Trays
for patients/residents on droplet
precautions are left on the trolley
and unit staff are notified. Trays are
delivered to patients/residents on
routine practices or contact
precautions.
Trays are not removed from patient
rooms for anyone on droplet
precautions. With gloved hands,
collect trays from patients/residents‘
on routine practices or contact
precautions. Gloves are removed
upon completion of tray pick-up,
discarded, and hands washed or
ABHR applied before leaving the
unit.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Nursing staff return the tray to the
trolley for anyone on droplet
precautions. Ensure the trolley is left
uncovered.
Page 58
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Airborne Precautions
(Blue Sign)
Unit Staff
Food Service Worker
Tray Delivery
Wash hands prior to tray delivery.
Disposable gloves not required
Over bed table must be free of
debris. Tray is taken directly from
the trolley and delivered by nursing
staff to patients/residents on
airborne precautions.
Do Not Enter the room. Trays for
anyone on airborne precautions are
left on the trolley and the unit staff
notified. Trays are delivered to
patients/residents on routine
practices or contact precautions.
Tray Pick-up
Wear disposable gloves
Nursing staff return the tray to the
trolley for anyone on airborne
precautions. Ensure the trolley is left
uncovered.
Trays are not removed from patient
rooms for anyone on airborne
precautions. With gloved hands,
collect trays from patients/residents‘
on routine practices or contact
precautions. Gloves are removed
upon completion of tray pick-up,
discarded, and hands washed or
ABHR applied before leaving the
unit.
12. Healthy Workplace
While the focus of the Infection Prevention and Control program is on protection of the
patient, Occupational Health & Safety‘s mandate is to protect the health and safety of VIHA
staff.
Employee Health Advisors provide occupational health nursing services to staff through
prevention and health promotion activities. They maintain close communication and
collaboration with Infection Prevention and Control. Information on the Occupational Health &
Safety program can be found at: http://www.viha.ca/occupational_health.
13. Recreational Reading Material and Games
For normal operations outside of an outbreak situation: Magazines, book and puzzles in
optimal condition may be placed in waiting areas and patient lounges for everyone‘s
enjoyment. If magazines/books/puzzles are torn, soiled or wet they must be removed and
discarded.
For operations during an outbreak situation: Magazines/books/puzzles/clutter will be
removed from waiting rooms and patient lounges, in order to ensure required additional
cleaning can be achieved. The Infection Prevention & Control Program will provide direction
for the removal of magazines/books/puzzles/clutter from waiting rooms and patient lounges,
during these times.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 59
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
C.
Education
The final, and it could be argued the most important, element of routine practices is
Education. The ongoing acquisition of knowledge related to what are the best infection
prevention and control strategies and the communication of that knowledge to fellow
professionals, patients/residents and visitors, followed by the demonstration of these skills in
day to day practice, and are the keystones to ensuring the ongoing safety of VIHA
patients/residents and staff.
The following are ways in which education can be used to break the chain of transmission.
Understanding infection prevention and control practices.
Understand and demonstrate work practices that reduce the risk of infection (e.g. hand
hygiene, proper use of PPE, be immunized, and do not come to work with a
communicable disease).
Who provides infection prevention and control expertise to your setting? Who would
you call for help? (See list of VIHA Infection Control Practitioners on the Contact Us
navigation bar.)
Educate patients/residents/families about hygiene and infection prevention strategies such
as hand hygiene.
Know where to find in your facility (or who to ask for) standardized education materials
on infection reduction strategies such as hand hygiene, respiratory etiquette, and
influenza vaccination
Be able to identify unusual clusters or illnesses (e.g. respiratory, gastrointestinal, skin);
and be aware of person, time, place tracking; and report to the appropriate person
Infection prevention and control health promotion
Attend in-services and read scientific literature on infection prevention and control
Provide leadership and act as a role model to other healthcare providers,
patients/residents and visitors with regard to infection prevention and control principles
(e.g. communicate new/current material to other health professionals and
patients/residents/families)
Demonstrate work practices that reduce the risk of infection (e.g. use hand hygiene,
use proper equipment, be immunized, and do not come to work with a communicable
disease)
Modified from: Siegel JD, Rhinehart E, Jackson M, Chiarello L, and the Healthcare Infection Control Practices
Advisory Committee, 2007 Guideline for Isolation Precautions: Preventing Transmission of Infectious Agents in
Healthcare Settings, June 2007
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 60
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2.
ADDITIONAL PRECAUTIONS
Additional Precautions are required when routine practices are not sufficient to prevent
transmission of certain microorganisms. 7
For example, additional precautions are warranted for:
Diseases, either suspected or confirmed, during the infectious state
Situations in which contamination of the patient‘s environment is likely (e.g. a patient
with diarrhea that cannot be contained)
Patients/residents infected (and/or colonized in acute care) with certain organisms of
interest that may be transmitted easily by direct or indirect contact with the patient
(intact skin, wounds, or coughing) or with their environment
Reference: Public Health Agency Canada (1999) Infection Control Guidelines; routine practices and additional
precautions for preventing transmission of infection in healthcare. Health Canada.
A.
Contact Precautions
1. Purpose
Contact Precautions are intended to prevent transmission of infectious agents, including
epidemiologically important microorganisms, which are spread by direct or indirect contact
with the patient or the patient‘s environment, e.g. scabies, antibiotic resistant bacteria (MRSA,
ESBL).
The application of contact precautions for patients/residents infected or colonized with
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms.
Contact Precautions also apply where the presence of excessive wound drainage, fecal
incontinence, or other discharges from the body suggest an increased potential for extensive
environmental contamination and risk of transmission of microorganisms. The specific agents
and circumstances for which contact precautions are indicated are found in Appendix A.
7
It is important to be sensitive to the effect that Additional Precautions have on patients and others. Patients
can feel stigmatized by all the paraphernalia (e.g. gowns, masks, etc) and other patients/visitors may be
concerned about their own personal safety. It is best to advise all concerned that the interventions are taken to
protect everyone – patients, staff and the public alike.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 61
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement
Contact precautions signage must be posted on the door and by patient‘s bed in multibed rooms. (See Contact Precautions poster, Catalogue # 0040506, on the Precaution
Signs navigation bar on the Infection Prevention and Control website)
A single-patient room is preferred for patients/residents who require contact
precautions
The door may be left open
When a single-patient room is not available, consultation with the Infection Control
Practitioner is recommended to assess the various risks associated with other patient
placement options (e.g. cohorting, keeping the patient with an existing roommate)
In multi-patient rooms, at least two meters (6 feet or more) spatial separation between
bed and curtain is advised to reduce the opportunities for inadvertent sharing of items
between the infected/colonized patient and other patients/residents
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 62
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
3. Contact Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors
Staff
Patients/Residents
Visitors
Routine practices to be followed
at all times
Patients/residents leaving room
for tests/mobilization/
rehabilitation will do so with
permission of healthcare provider
Hand hygiene will be performed
upon entering/leaving the facility
and the patient‘s room
Healthcare personnel will wear
appropriate PPE for all
interactions that may involve
contact with the patient/patient
environment
Patients/residents will perform
hand hygiene upon exiting and
re-entering unit/room
Visitors/relatives will wear
appropriate PPE when providing
care or very close patient
contact, as directed by
responsible nurse
PPE will be changed following
procedures, between
patients/residents or when
heavily contaminated/torn/split
during a procedure
Patients/residents will wear a
clean nightgown/house coat or
clothes
Visitors will not visit multiple
patients/residents/rooms during
a visit
Ensure single use and
dedicated patient equipment for
the duration of precautions -i.e.
dedicated commode
Patients/residents‘ wounds will
be covered with a fresh dressing
Visitors must not visit public
areas within the facility (unit
kitchen, cafeteria, shops/kiosks
in main entrance etc.) and
SHALL NOT use the
patient/resident bathroom
Shared equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
prior to removal from precaution
room and before further use
All dedicated equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
on discharge of patient /
discontinuation of precautions
and prior to removing from
patient room
Diagnostic procedures will not
be postponed, inform receiving
department of necessary
precautions on the requisition or
advising by telephone. Attempt
should be made to book
infectious cases at the end of
the day
Linen and garbage will be
placed in regular bags and
closed securely prior to removal
from room
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 63
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
B.
Droplet Precautions
1. Purpose
Droplet Precautions are intended to prevent transmission of pathogens spread through
close respiratory or mucous membrane contact with respiratory secretions. Droplet route
means spread by large particle droplets when patients/residents cough, sneeze or talk (i.e.
within a radius of two meters, or 6 feet).
Because these pathogens do not remain suspended over long distances in a healthcare
facility, special air handling and ventilation are not required to prevent droplet transmission.
Infectious agents for which droplet precautions are indicated are listed in Appendix A and
include B. pertussis, influenza virus, adenovirus, rhinovirus, N. meningitidis, and Group A
streptococcus (prior to and for the first 24 hours of antimicrobial therapy).
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement
Droplet Precautions sign must be posted on the door and next to patient‘s bed in multi-bed
rooms. (See Droplet Precautions poster, Catalogue #0040508, on the Precaution Signs
navigation bar on the Infection Prevention and Control website.)
During periods of high census, patients/residents on droplet precautions might be placed in a
two or four-bed room. A green Droplet Precaution sign will be posted outside the room as
well as on the curtain of the affected patient within that room.
Single Room: the doors to single rooms can be kept open
When a single-patient room is not available, consultation with infection prevention and
control personnel is recommended to assess the various risks associated with other
patient placement options (e.g. cohorting patients/residents with the same infection,
keeping the patient with an existing roommate)
Spatial separation of at least two meters (6 feet or more) from patient to curtain and
drawing the curtain between patient beds is especially important for patients/residents
in multi-bed rooms with infections transmitted by the droplet route
3. Droplet Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors
Staff
Routine practices to be
followed at all times. Gown,
gloves and a surgical grade
mask (120 mmHg) with visor
will be worn within 2 metres (6
feet) of the patient. Particularly
important when care promotes
respiratory secretions, e.g.
nebulisers, suctioning
Patients/Residents
Patients/residents leaving
room for tests/mobilization/
rehabilitation will do so with
permission of healthcare
provider
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Visitors
Hand hygiene will be performed
upon entering/leaving the facility
and the patient‘s room
Page 64
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Staff
Patients/Residents
Visitors
PPE will be changed following
procedures, between
patients/residents or when
heavily contaminated/torn/split
during a procedure
Will wear a surgical grade
mask (120 mmHg) without
visor with ear loop design,
fitted to the face
Visitors/relatives who are
providing care or very close
patient contact within 2 metres (6
feet), will wear a surgical grade
mask (120 mmHg) with ear loop
design and attached visor.
Additional appropriate PPE will
be worn when directed by
responsible nurse
Ensure single use and
dedicated patient equipment
for the duration of precautions i.e. dedicated commode
Patients/residents will perform
hand hygiene upon exiting
and re-entering unit/room
Visitors will not visit multiple
patients/residents/rooms during a
visit
Shared equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
prior to removal from
precaution room and before
further use
Patients/residents will wear a
clean nightgown/house coat or
clothes
Visitors must not visit public
areas within the facility (unit
kitchen, cafeteria, shops/kiosks in
main entrance etc.) and SHALL
NOT use the patient/resident
bathroom
All dedicated equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
on discharge of patient /
discontinuation of precautions
and prior to removing from
patient room
Patients/residents‘ wounds will
be covered with a fresh
dressing
Diagnostic procedures will not
be postponed, inform receiving
department of necessary
precautions on the requisition
or advising by telephone.
Attempt should be made to
book infectious cases at the
end of the day
Linen and garbage will be
placed in regular bags and
closed securely prior to
removal from room
C.
Airborne Precautions
1. Purpose
Airborne Precautions prevent transmission of infectious agents that remain infectious over
long distances when suspended in the air (e.g. measles virus, varicella zoster virus
[chickenpox], pulmonary tuberculosis, smallpox and possibly SARS-CoV). See Appendix A
for detailed list.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 65
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Requirements – Signage and Placement
Airborne Precautions sign should be posted on the door indicating N95 mask and other
appropriate precautions. (See Airborne Precautions poster, Catalogue #0040504, on the
Precaution Signs navigation bar on the Infection Prevention and Control website.)
The preferred placement for patients/residents who require Airborne Precautions is in
a Negative Pressure Room. A Negative Pressure Room is a single-patient room that is
equipped with special air handling and ventilation capacity.
Negative Pressure Rooms have:
Monitored negative pressure relative to the surrounding area
12 air exchanges per hour for new construction and renovation and 6 air exchanges per
hour for existing facilities
Please access the Infection Prevention and Control internal web site for a list of Negative
Pressure Rooms throughout VIHA
In settings where airborne precautions cannot be implemented due to limited engineering
resources (e.g. Residential Facilities):
Place the patient in a private room
Keep the door to the room closed
Have the patient wear a surgical grade mask (if possible)
Staff and visitors must wear an N95 mask when in patient room
Arrange for transfer of patient to a facility with a Negative Pressure Room. Contact
Infection Prevention and Control. (See list of Infection Control Practitioners on the
Contact Us navigation bar on the Infection Prevention and Control website)
NOTE: Facilities Maintenance and Operations Department must be contacted when a
Negative Pressure Room is required to verify that the room is monitored and airflow remains
negative to surrounding areas.
3. Airborne Precautions – Staff, Patients/Residents, Visitors
Staff
Routine practices to be
followed at all times. All staff
entering patient‘s room,
escorting , treating or
examining the patient must
wear a high efficiency N95
mask – the type and size for
which they have been fit tested
Patients/Residents
Patients/residents must remain
in the room unless medical
condition warrants
urgent/emergent procedure
/intervention.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Visitors
Hand hygiene will be performed
upon entering/leaving the facility
and the patient‘s room
Page 66
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Staff
Patients/Residents
Visitors
Wherever possible, non
immune health care workers
should not care for
patients/residents with vaccine
preventable airborne diseases
If the patient is required to
leave the room for diagnostic
procedures, patient will wear a
surgical grade (120 mmHg)
fluid resistant mask (without
visor), fitted to the face – if
their respiratory status permits
Visitors/relatives will wear
appropriate PPE when providing
care or very close patient
contact, as directed by
responsible nurse. All visitors,
whether or not providing care,
must wear a surgical grade (120
mmHg) fluid resistant mask
(without visor)
The doors to the room must be
kept closed
Patients/residents on airborne
precautions are not permitted
to go outside for a cigarette –
alternative nicotine source
ordered by MRP
Instructions on application of
surgical grade (120 mmHg) fluid
resistant mask (without visor)
must be provided and use
encouraged
Following a risk assessment,
routine practices may dictate
the use of gloves and gown
during the episode of care
Patients/residents will perform
hand hygiene upon exiting
and re-entering unit/room
Visitors will not visit multiple
patients/residents/rooms during a
visit
PPE will be changed following
procedures, between
patients/residents or when
heavily contaminated/torn/split
during a procedure
Visitors must not visit public
areas within the facility (unit
kitchen, cafeteria, shops/kiosks in
main entrance etc.) and SHALL
NOT use the patient/resident
bathroom
Ensure single use and
dedicated patient equipment
for the duration of precautions i.e. dedicated commode.
Individual sharps container
must be in the room/ante room.
Limit equipment and personal
items. Used equipment is
placed in Central
Sterilizing/Processing bin.
Items must be cleaned prior to
placing in the bin
Shared equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
prior to removal from
precaution room and before
further use
All dedicated equipment will be
decontaminated appropriately
on discharge of patient /
discontinuation of precautions
and prior to removing from
patient room
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 67
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Staff
Patients/Residents
Visitors
Diagnostic procedures will not
be postponed, inform receiving
department of necessary
precautions on the requisition
or advising by telephone.
Attempt should be made to
book infectious cases at the
end of the day
Linen will be placed in regular
bags and closed securely prior
to removal from room
Garbage will be placed in
regular bags and closed
securely prior to removal from
room. Use of biomedical waste
bags is not necessary
Dietary staff do not deliver or
remove food trays for rooms
with patients/residents on
airborne precautions. Regular
dishes are to be used
4. Actions when Negative Pressure Room Not Available or
Malfunctions
The following steps should be followed if a facility does not have a Negative Pressure room:
Consult with Infection Prevention and Control to determine risk
Place patient in private room
Keep windows and door to room closed, even if the patient is not in the room
Turn off bathroom fan
Have patient wear surgical grade mask if possible when healthcare staff and/or visitors
are in the room
Staff and visitors must wear surgical grade (120 mmHg) fluid resistant mask (without
visor) when in patient room
Arrange for transfer to facility with Negative Pressure Room
The following steps should be followed when the Negative Pressure Room monitoring system
indicates a failure with the system:
Check that windows and doors are closed.
Contact Facilities Maintenance and Operations (FMO) immediately.
If FMO determines the problem cannot be fixed, follow the above policy for a facility
with no Negative Pressure Room
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 68
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Note: FMO must post, or have available, a record of inspection and maintenance verifying
the efficient operation of these negative air pressure room technologies. A regular schedule
of inspections of such rooms must be established and maintained. There should be daily
monitoring of negative pressure by nursing staff when room is in use.
D.
SUMMARY OF PRECAUTIONS
Table 9: Precautions Table
Contact
Droplet
Airborne
MRSA, Clostridium difficile ,
lice, scabies
N. menigitidis,
Mumps, Pertussis,
Norovirus, vomiting,
Influenza,
invasive Group A
streptococcus
Pulmonary Tuberculosis,
Measles, Chickenpox,
disseminated Zoster
Syndromic
Precautions
Draining wound,
diarrhea NYD,
infestation
Toxic Shock,
2 or more of the following:
Stiff neck
Fever
Headache
Malaise
Acute cough
Fever, weight loss+ cough,
high TB risk,
disseminated rash + fever
Private Room
Preferred
Preferred.
If in multi-bed room
draw curtains
YES
Negative Pressure
Room
NO
NO
YES
Gown + Gloves
Gown + Gloves +
Surgical grade (120 mmHg)
fluid resistant mask with face
shield
Gown + Gloves +
8
N95 mask
Gown + Gloves
9
if providing direct care
Surgical grade (120 mmHg)
fluid resistant mask with
attached face shield
(gown + gloves if providing
2
direct care )
Surgical grade (120 mmHg)
fluid resistant mask
(gown + gloves if providing
2
direct care )
Organism Based
Precautions (not
complete list)
Staff Personal
Protective
Equipment
Visitor Personal
Protective
Equipment
8
9
*
Fit tested
Direct care = hands on care (i.e. bathing, dressing changes, toileting)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 69
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Contact
Transporting patient
(need for Surgical
grade 120 mmHg
fluid resistant mask)
Patient – NO
Staff - NO
Droplet
Airborne
Patient – YES (if condition
Patient – YES (if condition
Staff –
allows)
YES (with attached face
shield)
allows)
Staff – NO (must wear N951)
10
Routine Plus
2 Step for C. Difficile and
11
Diarrhea NYD
Routine Plus
CDH, NRGH and PCC at RJH
only:
CDH, NRGH and PCC at RJH
only:
CDH, NRGH and PCC at RJH
only:
Precaution Clean
Precaution Clean
Precaution Clean
*
3
Routine Plus
3
Cleaning
E.
Protective (Reverse) Precautions
Patients/residents with a suppressed or deficient immune system may be at increased risk of
acquiring infection during hospitalization. Gowns, gloves and masks are not routinely
required. Instrumentation (e.g. catheters and other devices) is to be used only when
essential.
The physician decides whether or not the patient requires Protective Precautions. Variables
the physician may consider are:
Severity of immune system depression
Length of time patient has been neutropenic
Absolute neutrophil count of 0.5 x 109/1 or less (Neutropenia)
Procedure
Routine practices are to be followed at all time including strict hand washing prior to all
patient contact
Place in a single room (preferably a Positive Pressure Room if available). Keep door
closed. Place sign on door to notify other staff
Limit raw vegetables and fruit. Fresh flowers are not allowed in the room
10
Routine daily cleaning using Quaternary ammonia 1:256 (VirEx). Curtains changed on
discharge/discontinuation of precautions
11
Accelerated hydrogen peroxide 1:16 (VirOx), area cleaned twice in 24 hours during patients stay, and twice in
a row on patient discharge – where ―2 Step Post-it Note‖ posted by nursing staff
5 Precaution Clean using Accelerated Hydrogen Peroxide 1:16 (VirOx). Curtains changed on
discharge/discontinuation of precautions
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 70
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Offer bottled/filtered water and commercially prepared single serving fruit juices
Staff aware of incubating or having infection must not care for these patients/residents
Visitors with any signs and symptoms of infection should be encouraged to avoid
patient contact
F.
Management of Cases on Additional Precautions in
Diagnostic Areas
Medical intervention and investigation should not be delayed because a patient requires
additional precautions (however, if the test or treatment can be provided in the patient room
this should be the first consideration).
Use PPE and precautions as indicated on the Additional Precautions sign on the door
of the patient‘s room
Porters must comply with precautions noted on signage, and must be instructed to
remove attire and wash hands upon completion of transport. All equipment used must
be appropriately cleaned following transport
Charts should not be left on patient‘s bed or given to patient to hold. If no other option
is available, charts can be housed in a disposable bag or pillowcase for transport
purposes
For actively infected patients/residents (if unsure consult with Infection Prevention and
Control), follow these procedures:
The patient should be taken directly to the procedure room and not left in the
corridor
For non-urgent cases, book as the last case of the day; this facilitates cleaning
of equipment
Limit the number of moves and exposure to surfaces whenever possible
Remove as much equipment as possible from the room
Close all cupboard doors to protect equipment from exposure
Use sheets to cover any equipment that cannot be encased or removed
Should staff require equipment from a cupboard or from under a cover while
performing diagnostic tests on infectious patients/residents, ensure that staff
remove gloves and wash hands prior to obtaining this equipment. It is important
that contamination of other packages does not occur, as many organisms can
survive in the environment for long periods
Upon completion of the procedure the patient should be returned to the unit as
quickly as possible
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 71
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 5: Management of Infected Patients/Residents on Precautions in Diagnostic Areas
Is patient on Additional Precautions?
Use Routine Practices for all care.
Routine Cleaning
NO
YES
Can test/procedure be done in
patient's room?
Apply Precautions as identified on
signage. Clean equipment post
procedure.
YES
NO
Is patient having an invasive
interventional procedure? (i.e.
Imaging)
Protocol B
YES
NO
What Personal Protective
Equipment is required?
Gloves and
Gown
Gloves, Gown
and Mask
Can patient wear a
mask?
NO
Protocol B
YES
PROTOCOL B:
Protocol A
Protocol A
PROTOCOL A:
Minimize patient and staff contact with equipment.
Clean patient and staff contact areas post-procedure.
Prepare environment:;

Schedule as last case

Close cupboard doors

Move unnecessary equipment as far from
patient as possible and cover with a sheet

Prepare tray/equipment
Use clean circulator only to access supplies
TerminalClean post procedure all contact
surfaces. (Closed cupboards which were not
entered and covered/untouched equipment do
not require cleaning.)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 72
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
G.
Discontinuing Additional Precautions
The table below outlines the criteria for discontinuing the use of additional infection control
precautions without prior consultation with an Infection Control Practitioner. Please notify
your Infection Control Practitioner when this occurs.
Table 10: Procedure for Discontinuing Additional Precautions
Routine Practices are used at all times. Additional precautions are in effect when symptoms of infection are
present or when concerning infectious diseases are diagnosed.
Additional Precautions may ONLY be discontinued when the following criteria are met:
Notify your IPC Practitioner when this occurs
PRECAUTIONS
REASON
ARO positive
C.difficile positive
Contact
Precautions*
Droplet
Precautions*
Airborne
Precautions*
CRITERIA
ONLY when authorized by Infection Prevention & Control
48 hours without diarrhea and formed/normalized stools are
documented
Diarrhea NYD
(no vomiting)
Stools formed/normalized x 48 hours and
Negative C.difficile toxin
Skin/soft tissue infection
or cellulitis
Wound culture results are not MRSA and
ARO culture results are negative and
Antibiotics given for 24 hours or more and
Clinical improvement observed
New or worsening cough
Responding to antibiotics given for 24 hours or more
OR
5 days since start of symptoms when a viral infection is
suspected (labs, physical findings)
AND
Culture of sputum or blood is negative for MRSA
AND
Negative viral swab for influenza
Suspected MRSA
with cough
Known MRSA with cough
Fever with rash NYD,
suspect Meningitis
Diarrhea NYD
with vomiting
Meets criteria in box above and
Negative ARO cultures
Suspected pulmonary TB
Concentrated AFB smears negative x 3
Diagnosed pulmonary TB
ONLY when authorized by Infection Prevention & Control
Chickenpox
Widespread Varicella
Zoster (Shingles)
Cough is resolved but must continue with Contact Precautions
Antibiotics given for 24 hours or more and
Clinical improvement observed.
No diarrhea or vomiting x 48 hours
All skin lesions crusted
Until lesions can be covered with dressings or are crusted over
* Immediately have the room “discharge” cleaned following VIHA Guidelines, Facility specific, even if the patient is
not being discharged from the Unit/Facility
However, your Practitioner, in consultation with the Infection Prevention & Control Physician,
may determine that precautions can be removed earlier for some situations (e.g. C.difficile).
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 73
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 4: HOUSEKEEPING
1.
Clean Environment
[NOTE: This includes direction relating to current housekeeping service levels only.]
PRINCIPLES:
As a guiding principle, all healthcare workers share the role of maintaining a clean
environment.
GUIDELINES:
Patient rooms, equipment used in the assessment and care of patients/residents,
diagnostic treatment and service delivery areas are to be cleaned and disinfected
according to the Infection Prevention and Control (IPC) standards described in this
document.
Environmental Support Services within the VIHA are to establish and maintain a clean,
sanitary, and aesthetically pleasing environment for patients/residents, staff and visitors.
The IPC Program will assist by advising on appropriate types of disinfectants for daily
routine use; advise on disinfectants for specific situations e.g. outbreaks of
epidemiologically significant organisms and when certain difficult to eradicate organisms
are present in the environment.
When purchasing new patient care equipment, consideration by the Program area must
be given to: (1) how easily it can be cleaned/disinfected and (2) determination of who will
have responsibility for cleaning it.
1. Quality Auditing
In addition to the audits done by Housekeeping Services and Environmental Support
Services, the IPC team or designates may from time to time conduct independent audits of
the environment, to determine adherence to quality management. Environmental cultures
to investigate outbreaks will be at the discretion of Infection Prevention & Control.
2. Evaluating Products
Evaluation of new products will be done in cooperation and consultation with
Environmental Support Services, Infection Prevention and Control, and Purchasing.
Approved disinfecting solutions and applications are listed in Section 3. Exceptions are
described under Enhanced Cleaning.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 74
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
The accelerated hydrogen peroxide cleaning and germicidal/disinfectant agent12 is the
recommended product for routine housekeeping work. In sites where accelerated
hydrogen peroxide is not used routinely, quaternary ammonium compounds are used.
The information in this box applies to Cowichan District Hospital, Nanaimo Regional
General Hospital and from March 13, 2011 for the Patient Care Centre at Royal
Jubilee Hospital
CDH, NRGH and PCC at RJH staff are advised that two cleaning processes are now
being performed throughout these sites:
Routine Cleaning – all daily cleaning in all areas except the operating department, which
will remain unchanged (refer to Section A).
Precautions Cleaning – single-step cleaning both daily, on discharge of the rooms or bed
spaces of patients/residents, or discontinuation of patients/residents on additional infection
prevention and control precautions. The procedure described for cleaning in the
Enhanced Discharge Clean will be followed (refer to Section B).
Cleaning products also have been changed, with a primary focus on removing dirt and
soiling which can harbor microorganisms. Disinfection is targeted at areas with
precautions.
Routine Cleaning – neutral detergent (e.g. Stride) for cleaning the environment and all
equipment and furnishings within the environment.
Precautions Cleaning - accelerated hydrogen peroxide (e.g. Virox) for cleaning
rooms/bed spaces of patients/residents on precautions, and all furnishings and equipment
used by those patients/residents (single step).
*Please Note: Section 1D – Separation of Clean and Soiled Equipment and Section 3 – Bed Bug Infestation
still applies to these sites
12
Use of accelerated hydrogen peroxide has been implemented in some hospitals, approval for its expanded
use is being considered.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 75
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
A.
ROUTINE CLEANING
1. DAILY CLEAN
Nursing Responsibilities:
Routine practices are used at all times when handling soiled items. Hand hygiene
is performed upon completion of the task
Patient care items to manage toileting and personal hygiene (bedpans, urinals,
commode pots and washbasins) are emptied and disinfected following use. When
done manually, the receptacles are to be emptied, washed or rinsed and then
surface wiped with the approved ready to use disinfectant wipe. When automated
washer disinfector/hoppers are installed in care areas, items placed in these are
cleaned using a sanitation cycle. DEKO Loading and Instructions The items
removed from the machine can be used for any patient
All receptacles containing body fluids that are not disposable by design (e.g. glass
suction canisters), are to be emptied and rinsed with cold water prior to transport to
CPS for terminal cleaning and disinfection
Patient care items (bedpans, urinals, washbasins) no longer required for care or
upon discharge of the patient, are rinsed to remove any visible debris and placed
into the designated CPS bin for pick up
Equipment for care and assessment e.g. NIBP mobile cart, thermometers,
Use regular facility germicidal/disinfectant solution.
Applicable to all rooms, including those on Additional Precautions, unless otherwise
specified (see Enhanced and Two-Step Cleaning). Staff must wear appropriate
Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 76
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Gloves, that meet WorkSafe BC standards for the task, are to be used for all work
requiring chemicals, cleaners, and disinfectants. Household non-disposable gloves
are preferred for ongoing use by housekeeping staff. They must be designated to
the individual worker, and must be inspected by the worker daily to ensure that the
gloves have no holes or tears in them. If gloves are damaged they must be
discarded and replaced. They must be dried and stored in a clean dry area. If
disposable gloves are used, then they must be changed regularly to ensure
integrity and cleanliness. Regardless of the type of glove, they must be washed
between dirty tasks and whenever the floor bucket disinfectant solution is changed
Floor bucket germicidal/disinfectant solutions are freshly prepared and frequently
changed at a minimum after every two large rooms (4-bed rooms) or three small
rooms (2-bed or private rooms)
As a general principle, high items are cleaned first, using a top-to-bottom approach
All cleaning equipment is disinfected at the end of each cleaning shift
The mop bucket and double bucket are to be washed and rinsed before refilling
Used mop heads are returned to the designated pick up area for transport to the
laundry
Clean rags and a fresh bucket of germicidal/disinfectant solution will be used for
each room to perform contact surface sanitizing.
Cleaning rags are to be used
only once -- DO NOT re-dip into solution. If flip top bottle of germicidal/disinfectant
solution is used instead of bucket, cleaning rag must be saturated. Used cleaning
rags are returned to the laundry area in accordance with internal housekeeping
procedure
The germicidal/disinfectant solution is to be applied to horizontal hand contact
surfaces leaving the surfaces wet so that the drying time of that surface is 3 to 5
minutes (or in accordance with manufacturer‘s recommendations to assure the
killing of micro organisms)
Dry dusting is to be avoided in clinical patient care areas. The approved
germicidal/disinfectant must be applied to an approved dust rag or mop, which is
then used to remove dust from horizontal surfaces, thus reducing the risk of
dispersing dust and micro organisms into the environment
Soap and alcohol based hand rub dispensers on wall-mounted and floor model
kiosks will be monitored daily. These dispensers include those found at elevators,
public entry points, bathrooms, and point of care. When these are empty, the
dispenser will be replenished with soap/ new alcohol product. Clean/wipe the
outside of the dispenser after refilling
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 77
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
b) Specific
The following environmental surfaces and equipment/furniture will be cleaned and
disinfected daily. Examples of items have been identified, but this is not an allinclusive list:
Central & POD Nursing Stations:
Horizontal and contact surfaces, telephones and receivers, hand hygiene
sinks including taps and faucets, alcohol based hand rub dispensers and
kiosks
Floors:
To be dust mopped followed by wet mopping with disinfectant solution.
(Exception – see Enhanced Cleaning if patients/residents on Additional
Precautions)
Furniture & Equipment:
Horizontal and contact surfaces of over bed tables, bedside tables, the bed
rails, handles and control panels, bedside chairs, telephone
Bedside equipment including: commode, wheelchair, Geri chair, lifting
devices and IV poles, etc
Sinks & Bathrooms:
Entire sink is thoroughly cleaned, all surfaces and fixtures, counter top,
entire toilet is thoroughly cleaned: seat (top and bottom), inside bowl, outside
base, walls around sink and toilet, door knobs, light switches, soap and
paper towel dispenser. All fixtures, such as handles, call bells and strings,
etc. are cleaned. All tubs and showers are thoroughly cleaned
Service/Utility Rooms:
Soiled and clean service rooms shall be cleaned and disinfected. Sinks and
hoppers will be cleaned and disinfected in a similar fashion to patient toilets.
Washer disinfectors shall be surface cleaned
Garbage Cans:
Garbage cans are emptied when full and at minimum once daily, and
cleaned/ disinfected inside and out at a minimum of once per week or when
visibly soiled
Laundry Receptacles:
Laundry receptacles are cleaned/disinfected inside and out each day
following removal of the bag liner or removal of the laundry bags
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 78
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Bed Cubicle:
Bedside curtains are changed if visibly soiled
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN
Nursing Responsibilities
Nurses remove all patient belongings. Patient care items such as wound care products, pericare products, creams, etc are sent home with the patient or discarded. Medical equipment
including used suction bottles and apparatus will be dismantled and removed from room.
Housekeeping Responsibilities
Use regular facility germicidal/disinfectant solution.
Applicable to all rooms unless otherwise specified, (see Enhanced and Two-Step
Cleaning).
For rooms on Additional Precautions, bedside curtains are removed and laundered.
Staff must wear appropriate PPE.
The housekeeping staff removes all linen from the bed or stored in the bed space. All
surfaces in the bed space/room as described under Routine Daily Cleaning are cleaned and
disinfected. In addition, the following will be cleaned and disinfected:
All surfaces of the bed including bed frame, headboard, footboard, light above bed,
pull cords, call bells, mattress, pillows, etc
The interior of bedside tables, over bed tables and closets
Any patient care equipment used by the patient that remains at the bedside, e.g.
Geri chair, commode chair, IV pole or pump
Television, TV remote, and telephone
Wall surfaces at the head of the bed including the medical gas flow meters and
suction apparatus holders when disposable and not sent to CPS. When suction
bottles and apparatus have not been used, the exterior of these will be disinfected
Bedside curtains are changed if visibly soiled
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 79
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Upon completion of cleaning, gloves are removed, hands washed, bed is made and
necessary supplies are replenished.
3. ROUTINE PLUS DISCHARGE CLEAN
For those bed space/room where the patient was discharged/transferred while still
on additional precautions the bedside curtains must be changed and the walls
washed
Upon completion of cleaning, gloves are removed, hands washed, bed is made and
necessary supplies are replenished.
SCHEDULED AND CYCLED CLEANING & DISINFECTION:
Cleaning and disinfection of the following items not captured during routine daily or discharge
cleaning will be managed on a cycled basis and following additional written policies.
Care & Assessment Equipment:
Contact surfaces of equipment used in the care and assessment of the patient
including fixed ceiling lift control devices, infection prevention and control barrier
supply carts, intravenous and nutrition administration pumps
In some areas, an arrangement has been made with Central Processing and Sterilization
departments to clean pumps such as gastric, IVAC, nutrition administration, continuous
pumps; crash cart and defibrillator, emergency cart, and continuous renal replacement
therapy (CRRT) machines.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 80
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
B.
ENHANCED CLEANING
1. DAILY CLEAN
Use accelerated hydrogen peroxide germicidal solution, mixed at a 1:16 ratio for all contact
surfaces including wall at head of bed; and mixed to a 1:64 ratio for floors and other walls.
Applies to rooms with VRE positive and exposed patients.
Applies when outbreak of any organism is declared, unless otherwise specified (see TwoStep Cleaning).
Cleaning checklist is used, signed off, and submitted to housekeeping supervisor.
Housekeeping Checklist
Staff must wear appropriate PPE.
In addition to the Routine Daily Clean procedures, specific enhanced cleaning techniques
and procedures are followed.
Nursing Responsibilities
Nursing will identify the need for enhanced daily clean in accordance with IPC guidelines (i.e.,
signage at the door). Post the green “enhanced” post-it note.
Housekeeping Responsibilities
The housekeeping cart containing all the necessary cleaning supplies and equipment is
placed outside the door. Freshly prepared germicidal/disinfectant solution, plenty of cleaning
rags, paper supplies, garbage bags, soap, sharps container and housekeeping keys are
placed in an easily accessible place on the cart.
Instructions for entry precautions outlined on the Infection Prevention and Control
Precautions sign on the door must be followed before entering room. Proceed to
gown, fasten gown ties at back, making sure gown edges overlap to cover uniform
completely; wear cap and mask if required. Put on disposable gloves and pull up over
cuffs of gown. An Infection Prevention and Control Barrier Supply Cart or alternative
may be located in the hall outside the room
All patient contact items are thoroughly cleaned using the enhanced cleaning
technique. Cloths will be pre-soaked in accelerated hydrogen peroxide based solution
and kept in a bag until used. A fresh cleaning rag is used for each item cleaned (1 for
the sink, 1 for the chair, etc.). Each used rag is discarded into a garbage bag and
when room is completely cleaned, the bag of cleaning rags is removed from room to be
laundered
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 81
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Note: The germicidal/disinfecting agent (mixed at a 1:16 ratio) is applied heavily enough to
assure a 5-minute contact/drying time, or consistent with manufacturer‘s instructions.
Wet mop floor with germicidal/disinfectant solution. Upon completion, mop handle is
wiped before it is placed back in the wet mop bucket. DO NOT DUST MOP ROOM
Upon completion of cleaning, prepare to exit room. Remove gloves by pulling inside
out; do not touch the outside of the gloves, if possible. Discard into garbage. Perform
hand hygiene. Pull off gown by pulling free and holding upper ties and inside surfaces.
Pull sleeves inside out when pulling arms out. Roll gown up with inside surface facing
out and place in garbage or if reusable gown, in linen hamper/tote by door. Garbage
must be contained in tied off bag before leaving room13. Wash hands before leaving
room. Please see also Donning and Doffing
Garbage is transported to designated pick up area. Return to housekeeping room with
cart, thoroughly clean and decontaminate housekeeping equipment. Remove mop
head and place in black garbage bag for laundering, transport to designated pick up
area. Use germicidal/disinfectant solution to thoroughly clean all equipment used –
mop handle, bucket, wringer, double bucket, keys, etc
Thoroughly wash hands and forearms using soap and water or use an alcohol based
hand rub product, in nearest utility room
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN
Use accelerated hydrogen peroxide germicidal solution, mixed at a 1:16 ratio for all contact
surfaces including wall at head of bed; and mixed to a 1:64 ratio for floors and other walls.
Applies to rooms with VRE positive and exposed patients.
Applies when outbreak of any organism is declared, unless otherwise specified (see TwoStep Cleaning).
Cleaning checklist is used, signed off, and submitted to housekeeping supervisor.
Housekeeping Checklist
Staff must wear appropriate PPE.
This type of cleaning is done when a patient has been found to have a microorganism
capable of living long periods in the environment and presents risk of infection in
patients/residents admitted to the room at a later time e.g. VRE. It is either done on
13
In most cases this will be regular waste and not biohazardous waste.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 82
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
transfer/discharge of the patient with the infection or when the patient is no longer exhibiting
symptoms of the infection.
All steps identified in Routine Discharge Cleaning are followed. In addition, cleaning of the
room and equipment/furniture includes vertical surfaces and fixtures, window treatments and
bedside curtains.
Window curtains are changed, and window blinds are surface
wiped/disinfected. Hydrogen peroxide disinfectant solution is used with attention to detailed
cleaning of difficult to clean surfaces e.g. call bell buttons, medical gas controls, bedside
commodes, bed controls, etc.
Nursing Responsibilities
Nursing will identify the need for enhanced daily clean in accordance with IPC guidelines (i.e.,
signage at the door). Post the green “enhanced” post-it note.
The Infection Prevention and Control Precautions sign must remain posted until the cleaning
is done.
All patient belongings are removed from the room
Open, unused medical supplies are to remain in the room to be discarded
Medical and patient equipment will be managed in the same manner as described in
Routine Discharge Cleaning
Housekeeping Responsibilities
The procedures described for cleaning in the Routine Discharge Clean and Enhanced
Daily Clean will be followed. In addition, the following procedures are also performed during
an Enhanced Discharge Clean: Housekeeping Checklist
Take minimal supplies into the room with precautions.
All exposed unused supplies are discarded into the garbage: toilet paper, bar soap,
gloves, bags, etc. If sharps container is full, remove it, wipe with disinfectant and place
in designated area. If not full, wipe exterior with disinfectant
All patient contact items are thoroughly cleaned: furniture, fixtures, sinks, call bell
cords, door knobs, exterior surfaces of soap and paper towel containers, etc
Change the cubical curtains and window drapes. If roller or venetian blinds, wipe with
disinfectant. Wash the ledges, over bed lights; wash the windows, window ledges,
walls; wash the bed (including frame and mattress); wash the radiators, cubical curtain
rails, shelves; wash the inside and outside of waste baskets
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 83
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Entire bathroom, tub and shower are thoroughly cleaned. Shower curtain is removed
for laundering
Wet mop floors of patient room and bathroom. Upon completion, mop handle is wiped
before it is placed back in the wet mop bucket. DO NOT DUST MOP ROOM
Once cleaning and sanitizing is complete; barrier clothing is removed and hand
hygiene performed
Bed is made and necessary supplies are replenished: toilet paper, paper towels, soap.
Housekeeping staff replaces the cubicle, shower and window curtains
Infection Prevention and Control Precaution sign is disinfected and removed from the
door. If sign is located in a Plexiglas Holder, the holder is disinfected and the sign is
flipped over so the back side showing hand hygiene is now visible. The Housekeeping
Checklist and any other ―Requires Cleaning‖ sign that has been used is removed,
initialed and submitted to the Housekeeping Supervisor
Housekeeping staff is to thoroughly clean and sanitize their equipment
Hands and forearms are washed with soap and water or with the alcohol based hand
rub product
C.
TWO STEP CLEANING
1. TWICE DAILY CLEAN
This is a process that includes:
Cleaning as set out for Enhanced Daily Clean completed twice during the day
Use accelerated hydrogen peroxide germicidal solution, mixed at a 1:16 ratio for
all contact surfaces including wall at head of bed; and mixed to a 1:64 ratio for
floors and other walls
Applies to rooms where patients have GI illness symptoms or confirmed
Norovirus, Clostridium difficile, Rotavirus, etc
Staff must wear appropriate Personal Protective Equipment (PPE)
In accordance with the Infection Prevention and Control Manual, Two Step Daily Clean may
be requested when the patient has an organism known to be resistant to standard
disinfectants.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 84
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Nursing Responsibilities
Nursing must place the appropriate Infection Prevention and Control sign on the door and
inform housekeeping staff of the need for Two Step Daily Clean in accordance with IPC
guidelines. Post the orange “2-step” post-it note.
Housekeeping Responsibilities
The procedures described for cleaning in the Enhanced Daily Clean will be followed, but
completed on two separate occasions during the day.
2. DISCHARGE CLEAN
This is a 2 step process that includes:
Cleaning as set out for Enhanced Discharge Clean
Once surfaces are dry, cleaning is repeated
Use accelerated hydrogen peroxide germicidal solution, mixed at a 1:16 ratio for all
contact surfaces including wall at head of bed; and mixed to a 1:64 ratio for floors
and other walls
Cleaning checklist is used, signed off, and submitted to housekeeping supervisor.
Housekeeping Checklist
Applies to rooms where patients have GI illness symptoms or confirmed Norovirus,
Clostridium difficile, Rotavirus, etc.
Staff must wear appropriate Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
In accordance with the Infection Prevention and Control Manual, Two Step Daily Clean may
be requested when the patient has an organism known to be resistant to standard
disinfectants.
Nursing Responsibilities
Nursing must place the appropriate Infection Prevention and Control sign on the door and
inform housekeeping staff of the need for Two Step Discharge Clean in accordance with IPC
guidelines. Post the orange “2-step” post-it note.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 85
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
The responsibilities described for cleaning in the Enhanced Discharge Clean will be
followed.
Housekeeping Responsibilities
The procedures described for cleaning in the Enhanced Discharge Clean will be followed,
and repeated a second time when the surfaces are dry.
.
D.
SEPARATION OF CLEAN AND SOILED EQUIPMENT
Clean and soiled equipment will be stored/held within separate designated areas on all units.
Areas will be identified using clear signage, for example:
Clean commodes only (Return all other equipment to designated area)
Clean equipment only
Soiled equipment only
Clean and soiled areas should be at least 2 metres (6 feet apart)
Once a piece of equipment has been cleaned using the appropriate method, a pink laminated
―Clean‘ tag will be attached. The tag will be removed prior to use of the equipment. The tag
will be cleaned appropriately prior to it being stored ready for further use.
Examples of equipment needing to be tagged following cleaning:
Commode chairs
Intravenous poles
Intravenous pumps
Wheelchairs
Walkers
Patient chairs
Once a piece of medical equipment is no longer needed by the patient, or a patient is
discharged/ discontinuation of precautions, the piece of medical equipment will remain within
the patient room/bed space and be removed following the appropriate cleaning process or, if
necessary, removed for cleaning in the Dirty Utility Room. If the equipment was in a room
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 86
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
where patients/residents were on precautions, it must remain there until appropriately
cleaned. The equipment will be tagged ‗clean‘ and stored in the appropriate designated area.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 87
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 11: Summary of Cleaning Requirements
Cleaning Requirements – Please refer to more complete information in the Guidelines
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
ROOM TYPE
14
Chemical
R
H
Regular rooms
X
15
C
Items
E
W
X
X
Room/bedspace with additional
precautions (i.e., MRSA)
X
X
ROOM TYPE
Bedside drapes if
soiled
Chemical
R H
C
Items
E W
X
X
X
X
Chemical
R
H
X
C
X
Items
E
W
X
Bedside drapes if
soiled
X
X
Specifics
Chemical
R H
X
S
Bedside drapes if
soiled
1. Diarrhea (unusual for patient)
2. GI organisms
(i.e., c-diff, Norovirus, etc.) Suspected or Confirmed
3. GI Outbreak
Second Time
Chemical
R
H
X
C
X
Items
E
W
*
X
S
X
X
X
*
X
X
C
X
R
Chemical
H
B
C
Items
E
W
Other (unusual or emerging) Suspected / Confirmed / Outbreak
Specifics
Bedside drapes if
soiled; * walls if
soiled
X
X
X
Bedside drapes
Items
E W
X X
Specifics
S
X
Bedside drapes & curtains
Chemical
R H
X
C
X
Items
E W
X X
X
X
X
Specifics
S
X
Bedside drapes & curtains
X
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
Specifics
S
R
Chemical
H B
C
At discretion and
direction of IPC
Practitioners
R = Regular Germicidal Solution H = Accelerated Hydrogen Peroxide
C = Contact Items (tables, rails, handles, switches, etc) E = Entire Room (total clean – walls, etc. included)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Bedside drapes if soiled
TWO STEP DISCHARGE CLEAN
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
ROOM TYPE
X
ENHANCED DISCHARGE CLEAN
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
ROOM TYPE
Specifics
S
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
ENHANCED DAILY CLEAN
1. An Outbreak (other than those
described under two-step)
2. VRE -Suspected or Confirmed
15
Specifics
S
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
ROOM TYPE
14
DISCHARGE CLEAN TYPE
Items
E W
Specifics
S
At discretion and direction
of IPC Practitioners
W = Washroom (all items)
Page 88
S = Special Requirement (list in ‗Specifics‘ box)
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2.
Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology
Level of Cleaning
Type of Clean
Cleaning chemicals to be
used
ROUTINE
ENHANCED
2-STEP
VIHA approved Quaternary Ammonium (e.g. VirEX
2) diluted 1:256 for contact surfaces;
OR Hydrogen Peroxide (e.g. VirOX 5, Accel)
diluted 1:16 for contact surfaces or 1:64 for floors.
VIHA approved Hydrogen Peroxide
(e.g. VirOX 5, Accel) product
VIHA approved Hydrogen Peroxide (e.g. VirOX 5, Accel)
product
Diluted 1:16 for contact surfaces or
1: 64 for floors
Diluted 1:16 for contact surfaces or 1: 64 for floors
Nursing responsible for identifying level of cleaning
required (e.g. MRSA, ESBL)
Nursing responsible for identifying level
of cleaning required (e.g. VRE)
Nursing responsible for identifying level of cleaning
required (e.g. GI illness)
DAILY
When No Precaution Sign Posted
Follow Routine Housekeeping cleaning procedure;
refer to housekeeping checklist.
Clean all contact surfaces.
Replace curtains if visibly soiled *.
PPE as per routine practice **
Precaution Sign & no Cleaning Notice Posted
Follow Routine Housekeeping cleaning procedure;
refer to housekeeping checklist.
Clean all contact surfaces.
Replace curtains if visibly soiled *.
Use PPE (Gown, Gloves, Mask as indicated on
sign) **
Precaution Sign & Enhanced Cleaning
Notice Posted
Follow Routine Housekeeping
cleaning procedure using hydrogen
peroxide solution; refer to
housekeeping checklist.
Clean all contact surfaces; and spot
clean walls
Replace curtains if visibly soiled *
Use PPE (Gown, Gloves, Mask as
indicated on sign) **
Precaution Sign & 2-Step Cleaning Notice
Cleaning occurs twice each day:
o
first clean in the morning
o
second clean in the afternoon
Follow Routine Housekeeping cleaning procedure using
hydrogen peroxide solution; refer to housekeeping
checklist.
Clean all contact and vertical surfaces.
Replace curtains if visibly soiled *.
Follow and complete housekeeping checklist and give
signed checklist to supervisor.
Use PPE (Gown, Gloves, Mask as indicated on sign) **
DISCHARGE(formally
known as “Terminal”)
Discharge or transfer of
a patient from a bed
Precautions have been
discontinued by
Infection Prevention
and Control – identified
as Routine Plus
discharge clean
When No Precaution Sign Posted
Routine discharge cleaning procedure; use
housekeeping checklist
Clean all contact and horizontal surfaces.
Replace curtains if visibly soiled and at least once
a month *
PPE as per routine practice **
Precaution Sign & Enhanced Cleaning
Notice Posted
Routine discharge cleaning procedure
using hydrogen peroxide; use
housekeeping checklist
Clean all contact, horizontal and
vertical surfaces.
Replace privacy curtains, including
window curtains within the bed
space/room *
Use PPE (Gown, Gloves, Mask as
indicated on sign) **
Precaution Sign & 2-Step Cleaning Notice
2-Step Cleaning Required
o Step 1. Clean with hydrogen peroxide solution to
remove organic debris. Allow to dry.
o Step 2. Disinfect – Wipe surface with cloth saturated
with hydrogen peroxide solution. The surface or item
is to remain wet for 5 minutes, then wipe or air dry.
Follow Enhanced discharge cleaning procedure using
hydrogen peroxide; use the 2-step cleaning process
above; Clean all contact, horizontal and vertical
surfaces.
Replace privacy curtains, including window curtains
within the bed space/room *
Follow and complete housekeeping checklist and give
signed checklist to supervisor.
Use PPE (Gown, glove, Mask as indicated on sign) **
Precaution Sign & no Cleaning Notice Posted –
identified as Routine Plus discharge clean
Routine discharge cleaning procedure, use
housekeeping checklist
Clean all contact , horizontal and vertical surfaces
Replace privacy curtains, including window
curtains within the bed space/room *
Use PPE (Gown, Gloves, Mask as indicated on
sign) **
* Bathroom cubicle curtains must be changed if visibly soiled and at least weekly, and daily for patients/residents with diarrhea, c.difficile or norovirus.
** Hand hygiene is to be performed between each patient environment and each time before gloves are put on and again after gloves are removed.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 89
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
3.
Bed Bug Infestation
If a bed bug infestation is suspected, contact the Housekeeping Supervisor through the call
centre.
Summary of Bed Bug Information
Biological Information:
Primarily active at night and hide during the day
Take advantage of small cracks and crevices/depressions
Require blood meal for development
Have sucking not chewing mouthparts (important for containing insect)
Egg to adult generally 45-55 days
Female produces between 200 to 500 eggs during lifetime
Typical life span between 6 to 12 months
Grow by shedding exoskeleton
Extreme heat (approx 45oC or cold is lethal – heat is more effective)
Generally not considered to vector disease (yet do harbour pathogens)
Are not good climbers on smooth surfaces
Reported - adults can live roughly 1½ years without a blood meal.
Signs of Infestation
Insect (up to ¼ inch – typically reddish-brown/yellow – may be white)
Fecal smears (digested blood) or spots on bedding/bed
Bite marks – typically raised welt with crust appearance (some no reaction)
Eggs – tiny in clusters – small, light coloured
Shed skeletons
Sweet/musty odour with severe infestation levels
Key Procedures
Important - obtain a specimen if possible
Treat area as if contaminated - assume contamination exists even if unsure
Contain patient possessions and infested items in sealed plastic
Never move any items from infested area without properly sealing in plastic (or
similar material)
Always label infested items and ensure separation from uninfested items
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 90
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Wash and Dry washable items using high temperature
Non-washable items can be dry cleaned
Ensure clean laundry and uninfested materials are not stored or transported with
infested materials where cross contamination can occur
There should be two distinct and separate protocols for handling dirty,
possibly contaminated laundry and other items. This will reduce the
possibility of cross-contamination
Vacuum beds and mattresses and surrounding area
Develop handling protocol - minimize contact or potential contact between patient
possession, clean/dirty laundry and potentially infested items
Steam cleaning can potentially be used
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 91
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 5: ANTIBIOTIC RESISTANT ORGANISMS
1.
Introduction
Antibiotic resistant organisms (AROs), also known as multi-drug resistant organisms
(MDROs), are defined as microorganisms that are resistant to one or more classes of
antimicrobial agents. Although the names of certain AROs describe resistance to only one
agent these pathogens are frequently resistant to a number of antimicrobial agents.
Examples of resistant bacteria are:
Methicillin Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA)
Vancomycin Resistant Enterococci (VRE)
Bacteria containing Extended Spectrum Beta-Lactamase (ESBL)
Or any bacteria resistant to usual antibiotic therapy, such as Burkholderia cepacia.
2.
Definitions
Colonization
Colonization is the presence, growth and multiplication of the organism in one or more body
sites without observable clinical symptoms.
Infection
Infection occurs when microorganisms invade a body site, multiplying in tissue and causing
clinical manifestations of local or systemic inflammation e.g. fever, redness, heat, swelling,
pain.
3.
Acute Care Screening Protocol
All patients/residents admitted to acute care hospitals will be screened using the ARO
Screening Questionnaire. Persons identified as having risk factors for MRSA acquisition will
be swabbed for MRSA.
Based on your assessment, perform actions as required — collect cultures and implement
additional precautions where appropriate.
Note: Notify Infection Prevention and Control of all patients/residents placed on additional
precautions.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 92
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Check the Patient Record disease alert field. This will be blank unless the patient has
previously been positive for an ARO.
Figure 6: Patient Record Disease Alert Field
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 93
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
If an ARO alert is present, the type of resistant organism will be identified according to the
following codes:
As soon as initial nursing risk assessment is complete, nursing staff can place
patients/residents on appropriate precautions (no need to wait for physician’s
directive).
Table 12: List of Organisms with Corresponding Precautions and Other Considerations
Code
Name of Organism
MRSA
Methicillin Resistant Staphylococcus
aureus
VRE
Vancomycin Resistant Enterococcus
ESBL
Extended Spectrum Beta Lactamase
BCEP
Burkholderia cepacia
KPC
Klebsiella pneumoniae carbapenemases
MRAB
Multi Drug Resistant Acinetobacter
baumannii
Multi Drug Resistant Pseudomonas
aeruginosa
MRPA
MRSP
Multi Drug Resistant Pneumococcus
MRTB
Multi Drug Resistant Tuberculosis
VRSA
Vancomycin Resistant Staphylococcus
aureus
New organism not listed above
Unusual combination of AROs listed
above
Other – ARO
Multiple AROs
Precautions and Other
Considerations in acute care16
Contact Precautions
Routine Plus Cleaning (bedside curtains
changed on discharge)
Contact Precautions according to VIHA‘s
Policy 15.3 Management of Patients with
VRE (Acute and Residential)
Contact Precautions
Routine Plus Cleaning
Cystic fibrosis patients/residents are
placed on Contact Precautions, in a
Private Room, do not cohort with another
diagnosed cystic fibrosis patient
Routine Plus Cleaning
Contact or Droplet Precautions
dependent on location of organism
Routine Plus Cleaning
Contact Precautions
Routine Plus Cleaning
Contact or Droplet Precautions
dependent on location of organism
Routine Plus Cleaning
Droplet Precautions
Preferably Private Room
Routine Plus Cleaning
Airborne Precautions
Negative Pressure Room
Routine Cleaning
Contact Precautions
Enhanced Cleaning
Discuss with IPC practitioner
Dependent on Organisms involved
16
Precautions are based on the acute care setting. In other settings, routine practices are generally sufficient,
unless identified differently by the IPC Practitioner.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 94
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
4.
ARO Screening and Collecting Swabs
Table 13: Screening and Specimen Collection
Encounter
Admission to
acute care
Screening
Questionnaire
YES
ARO Screening
Cultures
If positive response
to screening
questionnaire
Staff
responsible
for obtaining
cultures
If admitted via
ER/ED – RN
If direct admit –
MRN
MRSA
VRE
ESBL
Nares
Groin
Wound
Sputum if
productive cough
NO
Urine,
Rectum
Wound,
stoma, device
Admission to
Residential
Care
NO
If known MRSA
positive, swab
taken 30 days after
admission
Receiving
RN/LPN
Nares
Groin
Wound
Sputum if
productive cough
NO
NO
Admission,
discharge from
ICU or InPatient Renal
NO
All admissions and
discharges
NICU and Paeds
ICU: only transfers
from another
hospital (within or
external to VIHA),
and discharge from
unit
MRN
Nares
Groin
Wound
Sputum if
productive cough
Rectum
Wound
NO
Transfer
between VIHA
hospitals or
other hospitals
NO
All admissions who
have been
transferred from
another hospital
(within or external
to VIHA)
MRN
Nares
Groin
Wound
Sputum if
productive cough
NO
NO
* Hospice, End of Life, and stand-alone Palliative Care Units – contact IPC practitioner for direction.
5.
Overview of Antibiotic Resistant Organisms
In most instances, infections due to AROs have clinical manifestations that are similar or the
same as infections caused by susceptible pathogens. However, options for treating
patients/residents with these infections are often extremely limited due to their multiple
resistances to antibiotics. The result is that infections due to AROs often cause increased
morbidity and mortality, as well as increased length of hospital stay and costs.
The following factors contribute to emergence of resistance in this setting:
intensive, prolonged use of broad spectrum antibiotics
high intensity of medical care provided in the close physical confines of a hospital
a more vulnerable population, especially patients/residents suffering chronic illness,
those critically ill, those with invasive devices in place, those requiring intensive
medical or surgical care
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 95
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
A.
Methicillin-Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA)
Staphylococcus aureus (S. aureus) is a common cause of infection in hospital and the
community, causing a spectrum of problems from minor skin and wound infections, to serious
deep infections such as osteomyelitis and blood stream infection, which may be associated
with significant morbidity and mortality.
Staphylococcus aureus can survive on the skin, particularly the anterior nares, skin folds,
hairline, perineum and umbilicus, without causing infection. This is known as colonization.
Methicillin-Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA) are strains of S. aureus that are
resistant to antibiotics such as cloxacillin and cephalosporins. Cloxacillin is considered to be
identical to Methicillin (the drug used by the laboratory to detect resistance). MRSA are
cross-resistant to all cephalosporins, imipenem, meropenem, aminoglycosides, erythromycin
and quinolones, and they may also be resistant to many other antibiotics.
Certain strains of community-acquired MRSA can cause much more serious infections (eg.
Necrotizing pneumonia) than typical MSSA, in part due to a number of toxins of virulence
factors, including Panton Valentine Leukocidin (PVL) toxin.
In community settings the prevalence is unknown; however the following represent high-risk
groups:
injection drug users
dialysis or chemotherapy patients/residents
individuals living in Residential Care Facility
persons living on the street or using shelters
individuals in correctional facilities
individuals taking frequent and/or prolonged courses of broad spectrum antibiotics
chronically ill
persons will a skin infection that was difficult to treat
individuals discharged from healthcare facilities that were in hospital for a period longer
than 48 hours
individuals who have had a medical procedure in a medical clinic or who have been
hospitalized anywhere outside of Canada
B.
Vancomycin-Resistant Enterococci (VRE)
Enterococci are part of the normal flora of the gastrointestinal tract. They are organisms of
low virulence but can cause infections such as urinary tract infection, bacteraemia and
endocarditis, particularly in debilitated patients/residents. Acquired resistance to Vancomycin
has emerged in enterococci.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 96
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Most enterococcal infections arise from the patient‘s endogenous flora, but cross infection
between hospital patients/residents does occur.
Contact transmission, either directly from person to person or indirectly via contaminated
inanimate objects such as commodes or bedpans, plays an important role in mode of
transmission.
C.
Extended Spectrum Beta-Lactamase (ESBL)
Organisms
Extended Spectrum Beta-Lactamase is a bacterial enzyme with the ability to break down
(inactivate) a wide variety of antibiotics, including penicillins and all first, second and thirdgeneration cephalosporins. When present, this enzyme results in the bacteria being resistant
to antibiotic therapy.
ESBL enzymes are most commonly found in two bacteria – Escherichia coli (otherwise known
as E. coli) and Klebsiella pneumoniae, but can also be found in bacteria such as Salmonella,
Proteus, Morganella, Enterobacter, Citrobacter, Serratia, and Pseudomonas.
In many cases, ESBL bacteria can colonize the gut and other body sites without producing
disease. Significant infections include urinary tract infections and surgical wound infections.
Patients/residents whose gastrointestinal flora has been altered by previous antibiotic
treatment are predisposed to acquiring these pathogens.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 97
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
6.
ARO Room Placement
Figure 7: ARO Room Placement
Room Placement for a Patient Positive for an Antibiotic
Resistant Organism
Colonized Patient
Infected Patient
Single Room
Available?
Single Room
Available?
*YES
NO
NO
Place in Single Room
YES
Place in Double Room.
Prepare to manage
personal space.
*YES
Place in Single Room
Double Room
Available?
Double Room
Available?
YES
Place in Double Room.
Prepare to manage
personal space.
NO
Place in multi-bed room.
Prepare to manage
personal space.
NO
Consult with Infection
Prevention & Control
Place in multi-bed room. Confine
patient to bed space with curtains
drawn. Consult with Infection
Prevention & Control when available
*If more than one patient with same ARO on ward, it may be preferable to cohort in a semi-private or multi-bed room as appropriate
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 98
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Due to the limited number of single rooms available, where patients/residents must be placed
in a double or multi-bedded room, priority for the single room assignment should be as follows
(in priority order):
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Clostridium difficile infection
Diarrhea cause not yet diagnosed
MRSA infection
Patient colonized with multiple AROs
MRSA Colonization
Infection from other source
Special Considerations in Bed Placement for VRE
In some instances, VRE infected or colonized patients/residents will need VRE management
(i.e. patients/residents in a designated renal unit, an adult Intensive Care Units or pediatric or
neonatal Intensive Care Unit). In these instances, please refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.3
Management of Patients with VRE (Acute and Residential) for bed placement procedures.
7.
Key Management Issues
Table 14: Key Management Issues for MRSA and ESBL
Presentation
ARO status
Reservoirs
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
Infection or colonization of any body site;
most often skin and wound infections
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
A variety of gram negative bacteria, most
commonly Escherichia coli and Klebsiella
species have acquired ESBL. Usually found
in lower gastrointestinal tract, also in urine
and moist wounds.
A patient is colonized with MRSA when
culture report is positive for Staph. Aureus
resistant to cloxacillin with no clinical
symptoms or infection.
A patient is colonized with ESBL when a
culture report is positive for Extended
Spectrum Beta Lactamase with no clinical
symptoms or infection
Notice of previous colonization within a
VIHA facility will be recorded in:
The Health Record encounters and/or
Powerchart
The Admission Record which shows
―ALERT‖ for ARO status
Notice of previous colonization within a VIHA
facility will be recorded in:
The Health Record encounters and/or
Powerchart
The Admission Record which shows
―ALERT‖ for ARO status
Contaminated environmental surfaces
(floors, bed linens, over bed tables and
blood pressure cuffs) may also serve as a
reservoir.
Contaminated environmental surfaces such
as floors, bed linens, over bed tables and
blood pressure cuffs may also serve as a
reservoir.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 99
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Mode of
Transmission
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
Therefore, routine disinfection of the
environmental surfaces is necessary to
reduce the potential bacterial load.
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
Therefore, routine disinfection of the
environmental surfaces is necessary to
reduce the potential bacterial load.
Direct and indirect contact (see Part 2:
Transmission)
Direct and indirect contact (see Part 2:
Transmission)
The primary mechanism for transmission
of MRSA from one patient to another is via
hands that have become transiently
colonized either after direct contact with
colonized or infected patients/residents
while performing care, when removing
gloves or when touching contaminated
surfaces.
ESBL producing bacteria are spread through
feces and secretions (i.e. wound drainage,
sputum and urine) by direct contact with an
infected person. It can spread from patient
to patient on the hands of healthcare workers
or via contaminated devices.
Colonized or infected patients/residents
with large open, poorly healing wounds,
urinary incontinence with infected urine or
extensive desquamating skin conditions
are more likely to disperse large numbers
of organisms into the environment.
Droplet transmission is possible with
patients/residents who have a productive
cough and are MRSA colonized within their
nares/respiratory system.
Period of
Incubation
Likelihood of
Transmission
Precautions for
ARO Colonized
& Infected
Patients/
Residents
Variable
Variable
The likelihood of transmission increases in
patients/residents with:
Draining wounds or open skin lesions
Poor respiratory hygiene and coughing
Fecal or urinary incontinence, diarrhea,
ileostomy or colostomy, poor hygiene
Invasive devices in place
Requiring intensive contact care, i.e.
post CVA, dementia, post major
surgery, Intensive Care treatment
Requiring mobility assistance, i.e.
paraplegic, amputee
Infection due to greater number of
organisms present
The likelihood of transmission increases in
patients/residents with:
Urinary catheter
Diarrhea
Poor hygiene
Fecal or urinary incontinence, ileostomy or
colostomy
Requires intensive contact care, i.e. post
CVA, dementia, post major surgery,
Intensive Care treatment
Infection due to greater number of
organisms present
Routine practices are to be applied at all
times.
All patients/residents admitted to acute
care will be screened using the ARO
Screening Questionnaire. All
patients/residents identified ‗At Risk‘
will be swabbed for MRSA
Routine practices are to be applied at all
times.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Once colonization is confirmed:
The infection prevention and control
measures to prevent the spread of ESBL
are the same, whether the patient is
Page 100
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
Swab sites for MRSA will include
Nares
Groin (creases at junction of
torso with the legs, on either
side of pubic area)
Open wound(s)
All patients/residents admitted to an
intensive care unit or designated inpatient renal unit will be swabbed at
specific time frames – please refer to
page 2 of VIHA‘s Policy 15.2
Management of Patients with MRSA
(Acute Care)
Screening/swabbing for MRSA is not
required for residents being admitted
to or transferred from acute care to
Residential care. Residents –
previously identified as MRSA positive
– will be swabbed one month after
admission/transfer
The infection prevention and control
measures to prevent the spread of
MRSA are the same, whether the
patient is colonized or infected with
MRSA
Notify the Infection Control Practitioner
and ensure patient entered onto
Precautions log for unit. In acute and
residential care, post Contact
Precautions sign
Ensure ongoing communication of the
patient‘s status with other relevant
healthcare workers (e.g. diagnostics,
housekeeping etc).
Place the patient in an appropriate
room (see patient placement).
In acute and residential care, contact
precautions must be put in place
including donning a gown/apron and
gloves for all contact with the patient
and their physical environment. Ensure
contact Precautions sign is posted
Droplet precautions should be put in
place if the patient has a cough with or
without productive sputum
Provide the patient with dedicated
toilet/commode facilities.
Encourage the patient with meticulous
hand hygiene, particularly on leaving
the room and after toilet etc.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
colonized or infected with ESBL
In acute care, post Contact Precautions
sign.
In continuing care, apply contact
precautions for all close personal care
Notify the Infection Control Practitioner.
Ensure ongoing communication of the
patient‘s status with other relevant
healthcare workers (e.g. diagnostics,
housekeeping etc).
Place the patient in an appropriate room
(see patient placement).
Provide the patient with dedicated
toilet/commode facilities.
Encourage the patient with meticulous
hand hygiene, particularly on leaving the
room and after toileting etc.
Page 101
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
Staff Must:
Wear gloves and gown/apron for close
personal contact (remember bare
below the elbow when wearing an
apron)
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
Staff must:
Wear gloves for all casual contact
Wear gloves and gown/apron for close
personal contact (remember bare below
the elbow when wearing an apron).
Visitors must:
Visitors must speak with the patient‘s
primary nurse before visiting patient so that
proper precautions techniques and
procedures can be discussed.
Visitors must:
Provided visitors of patients/residents with
ESBL are healthy, there is no restriction on
visiting, and it carries no risk.
Visitors are required to adhere to contact
precautions and wear protective clothing
when providing patient care. Scrupulous
hand hygiene practices must be followed.
If visitors are not providing care, they are
not required to wear protective clothing,
BUT scrupulous hand hygiene practices
must still be followed whenever they leave
the room.
Patients/Residents must:
Wear clean dressing gown/clothing
when exiting the room
Wear shoes or slippers; no bare feet
Have a clean dry dressing covering any
skin/soft tissue infections
17
Acute Care Patients :
Mobilization and rehabilitation should be
restricted to those prescribed activities
that are essential to patient care
Are encouraged not to visit any common
areas on the unit or other patients‘
rooms
Visitors are required to adhere to contact
precautions and wear protective clothing
when providing patient care. Scrupulous
hand hygiene practices must be followed.
If visitors are not providing care, they are not
required to wear protective clothing, BUT
scrupulous hand hygiene practices must still
be followed whenever they leave the room.
Patients/Residents must:
Wear clean dressing gown/clothing when
exiting the room
Wear shoes or slippers; no bare feet
Have a clean dry dressing covering any
skin/soft tissue infections
Acute Care Patients:
Mobilization and rehabilitation should be
restricted to those prescribed activities
that are essential to patient care
Are encouraged not to visit any common
areas on the unit or other patients‘ rooms
Residential care patients
The resident can leave their room for all
activities, but is to be excluded from
food preparation activities
17
It must be remembered that a residential care facility is a resident‘s home and infection control precautions
must be balance with promoting an optimal, healthy lifestyle for the residents, particularly in view of the fact that
colonization or infection with AROs may persist indefinitely or may periodically re-emerge, despite treatment or
attempts at decolonization. Epidemiological studies indicate that ―Routine Practices‖ and the appropriate
Additional Precautions when providing close personal care in residential care facilities minimize the risk of
potential ARO transmission.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 102
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Decolonization
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
All patients/residents found to be MRSA
positive will be considered for topical
decolonization treatment, in an attempt to
eradicate MRSA and reduce the risk of
subsequent infection.
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
There is no decolonization therapy for ESBL.
For patients/residents infected with ESBL,
treatment is limited.
For Acute Care Facilities, please refer to
VIHA‘s Policy 15.2 - Management of
Patients with MRSA (Acute Care)
For Residential Care Facilities, please
refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.4 - Management
of Residents with MRSA (Residential Care)
Treatment
For infected patients/residents, treatment
is determined by the Most Responsible
Physician. Please refer to the
Antimicrobial Prescribing Guide for Adult
Patients: System Wide Initiative (SWI)
booklet for more detail
Treatment and repeat cultures should be
ordered by the Most Responsible Physician
in consultation with the Medical
Microbiologist or Infection Prevention and
Control Physician.
Discontinuation
of Additional
Precautions
For colonized patients/residents, wait 7
days post completion of any antibiotic
treatment (topical, oral or injectable) or
following decolonization.
Separate swabs from nares, groin and
any other sites previously found to be
positive
Two negative sets of swabs 7 days
apart (the first swabs must be negative
before doing the second set). Please
refer to VIHA‘s Policy 15.2 Management of Patients with MRSA
(Acute Care) and Policy 15.4 Management of Residents with MRSA
(Residential Care) for further
information
If first swab is positive, consider
decolonization if not already done so,
wait 7 days before doing another swab
Notify the Infection Control Practitioner
if the swabs have been done and are
negative
Wait 30 days post completion of any
antibiotic treatment (topical, oral or
injectable).
Separate swabs from rectum and any
other sites previously found to be positive
Urine specimen, specifying an ESBL
screen
Two negative sets of results 30 days apart
(the first swabs/specimens must be
negative before doing the second set)
If first swab/ specimen is positive, wait 30
days before doing another swab
Notify the Infection Control Practitioner if
the swabs/ specimens have been done
and are negative
For infected patients/residents, wait 30
days post completion of any antibiotic
treatment (topical, oral or injectible) prior to
initial set of swabs being taken. Then
follow the above steps
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 103
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Discharge or
Transfer
Environmental
Management
MRSA – Methicillin Resistant
Staphylococcus aureus
The Most Responsible Physician to
discharge the patient home as early as
their physical condition permits
The receiving facility or home care must
be notified prior to transfer for
patients/residents colonized or infected
with MRSA. The Most Responsible
Nurse must record status on the Home
Care Transfer Form
If cultures remain positive on discharge,
decolonization may be continued
following consultation with MRP
ESBL – Extended Spectrum Beta
Lactamase
The Most Responsible Physician to
discharge the patient home as early as
their physical condition permits
The receiving facility or home care must be
notified prior to transfer for
patients/residents colonized or infected
with ESBL. The Most Responsible Nurse
must record status on the Home Care
Transfer Form
Laundry
Waste
Cleaning
Laundry
Waste
Cleaning
Patient Care Equipment – once patient has
been discharged or precautions have been
discontinued, precaution signage will
remain in place and all patient equipment
will remain in the room. Equipment will
only leave the room once housekeeping
has disinfected it appropriately.
Patient Care Equipment – once patient has
been discharged or precautions have been
discontinued, precaution signage will remain
in place and all patient equipment will remain
in the room. Equipment will only leave the
room once housekeeping has disinfected it
appropriately.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 104
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 6: OUTBREAK MANAGEMENT
VIHA’s Infection Prevention and Control Program would like to thank Capital Health Region in Alberta, Canada
for generously sharing their Outbreak Prevention, Control and Management in Acute Care Facilities
document with us. The shared materials greatly assisted us in our development of this section of our manual.
1.
Introduction
Early recognition of unusual clusters of illness and swift actions in response to these episodes
are essential for effective management of outbreaks. It is vital that all healthcare workers
collaborate to facilitate prompt identification, reporting, specimen collection, and
implementation of appropriate infection prevention and control measures to help minimize the
impact of an outbreak.
Early recognition of suspected outbreaks is important. Patients/residents and staff should be
assessed on an ongoing basis for signs/symptoms of an infectious disease (see algorithm).
An outbreak may be declared anytime that the number of individuals presenting with similar
signs/symptoms exceeds the normal expected number of cases. Contact your Outbreak Lead
any time you are suspicious that an outbreak may be occurring within your unit.
The majority of outbreaks that occur are either respiratory or gastrointestinal. The following
case definitions were developed to assist in the early identification of ―unusual clusters‖ of
influenza-like (ILI) or gastrointestinal (GI) illness and/or outbreaks.
The purpose of this section of the manual is to provide current best practice/evidence-based
guidelines to assist staff with outbreak prevention, control, and management of outbreaks.
The information is divided into four sections:
Section A – General guidelines for management of any suspected outbreak activity.
Subsequently, these basic recommendations may be enhanced or modified depending on
identification of the causative agent.
Section B – Specific recommendations for the prevention, control, and management of
influenza outbreaks.
Section C – Specific recommendations for the prevention, control, and management of
outbreaks of gastrointestinal illness.
Section D – Specific recommendations for the prevention, control and management of
Clostridium difficile (CDI) and Scabies outbreaks.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 105
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2.
General Guidelines for Outbreak Management
A.
Reporting a Suspected Outbreak
Prompt reporting permits early identification and interventions to interrupt transmission,
reducing morbidity and mortality. Report any suspicion of an outbreak to the necessary
authority as soon as possible. The table below identifies whom to contact for your area.
Table 15: Contact List
Infection Prevention and
Control Contact
VIHA Infection Prevention and
Control
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control
Physician
VIHA Amalgamated LTCF
(Owned/Operated)
VIHA Infection Prevention and
Control
VIHA Infection Prevention and
Control Physician
VIHA Affiliated LTCF, Private
LTCF, and Community
Public Health: CD Nurses (ILI);
CD Environmental Health
Officers (NLI)
Public Health Medical Health
Officers (MHO)
Type of Facility
VIHA Acute Care
Medical Physician Contact
After hours contact
Medical Microbiologist on-call – covers all medical microbiology calls and any URGENT
infection prevention and control issues that cannot wait until the IPC practitioner is available.
(Paged through the RJH switchboard (250-370-8000).
Weekends/Stat Holidays – IPCP On-Call from 0930-1730 hours, for all acute care hospitals,
St. Joseph‘s Acute and Residential, and all VIHA-owned residential facilities. Contact via
your manager-on-call who has the number for the IPCP on-call.
Medical Health Officer on-call – Covers all questions from affiliated continuing care
facilities. (MHO Numbers)
1. Initial Infection Prevention and Control Precautions
Routine practices are to be used at all times with all patients/residents.
In addition, based on the type of outbreak, appropriate Additional Precautions will need to be
implemented as soon as possible.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 106
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
It is essential to NOT wait until the causative agent is identified before implementing
Additional Precautions. Initiate appropriate additional precautions as soon as a patient
presents with symptoms.
The appropriate type of precautions (e.g. contact and/or droplet) must be determined by the
presenting symptoms and the procedure being undertaken (e.g. mask with visor for any
cough inducing procedure for suspected ILI). Precaution signs should be posted on the
entrance to each affected room and elsewhere as directed by your Outbreak Lead.
The Suspected Respiratory Infection or Gastroenteritis Outbreak algorithm provides guidance
as to what initial infection prevention and control precautions are required in the event of any
ILI/GI outbreak.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 107
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 8: Suspected Respiratory Infection or Gastroenteritis Outbreak Algorithm
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 108
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Confirming an Outbreak
The Infection Control Practitioner, in consultation with the Infection Prevention and Control
Physician and/or the Infection Prevention and Control Manager, will review the data and
confirm that an outbreak is occurring.
The IPCP will notify other areas of the organization that the unit/facility is on Outbreak Status
(i.e. sending out a memo and/or in the case of Residential Facilities, posting on Healthspace).
3. Outbreak Management
In the event of an outbreak in a VIHA facility, Infection Prevention and Control will work
collaboratively with the outbreak team to investigate, identify, and plan the management of
the outbreak.
4. Compiling a Post-Outbreak Investigation Summary
Within VIHA facilities, the Infection Prevention and Control Team will lead the preparation of
an outbreak summary once the outbreak is declared over. The Clinical Coordinator, Manager,
Team Leader and the Occupational Health & Safety representative are expected to be key
contributors to the summary. Once a summary is complete it is reviewed by the Infection
Prevention and Control Team and key issues/concerns and/or successes are escalated to the
Infection Prevention and Control Quality Committee for its review.
B.
Influenza-Like Illness (ILI) Outbreaks
1. Introduction
Outbreaks of influenza generally occur in Canada between fall and early spring. Influenza
viruses cause disease among all age groups. Rates of serious illness and death are highest
among persons aged 65 years or older and in persons of any age who have medical
conditions that place them at increased risk from complications of influenza. In most local
outbreaks, complications and/or deaths related to influenza A occur in the elderly,
immunocompromised and pediatric patients/residents.
It is recommended that each facility have a process in place to ensure eligible inpatients
receive influenza immunization each year.
Annual influenza immunization is the primary tool for preventing influenza and its severe
complications. According to the Canadian National Advisory Committee on Immunization
(NACI) statement on influenza vaccination, all healthcare workers have a duty to promote,
implement, and comply with influenza immunization recommendations to decrease the risk of
infection and complications in vulnerable populations for which they provide care.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 109
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
NACI considers the provision of influenza immunization for healthcare workers to be an
essential component of the standard of care. To prevent transmitting influenza to those at
high risk of influenza related complications, all healthcare providers should receive annual
influenza immunization, unless contraindicated.
Outbreaks of influenza can be propagated when staff immunization rates are low even though
immunization rates in patients/residents may be high. The optimal time for delivering
organized immunization campaigns for both patients/residents and staff is in the autumn.
Effectiveness of the influenza vaccine is dependent on the age and immunocompetence of
the person receiving the vaccine and the similarity of the virus strains in the vaccine and
those in circulation during the influenza season. Although elderly persons and those with
chronic diseases may have a lower immune response to the vaccine than healthy young
adults, the vaccine is still very effective in preventing lower respiratory tract infections such as
pneumonia and other secondary complications, thereby reducing the risk for hospitalization
and death.
The influenza virus changes from year to year so the vaccine is adjusted to match with the
viruses expected to be circulating during the current influenza season. Each spring the World
Health Organization, CDC Atlanta, and the Public Health Canada Agency decide on the three
components of the vaccine.
For the current influenza vaccine information see the National Advisory Committee on
Immunization (NACI) and for FAQs the BC Healthfiles
2. Confirming an ILI Outbreak
The following two tables help to differentiate between signs and symptoms of influenza and
other respiratory organisms.
Table 16: Common Differences between Influenza and Common Cold Symptoms
Symptoms/Description
Influenza
Common Cold
Fever
Usually high
Sometimes
Chills, aches, pain
Frequent
Slight
Loss of appetite
Sometimes
Sometimes
Cough
Usual
Sometimes
Sore throat
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sniffles or Sneezes
Sometimes
Common
Involves whole body
Often
Never
Symptoms appear quickly
Always
More gradual
Extreme Tiredness
Common
Rare
Complications
Pneumonia - can be life
threatening
Sinus infection
Ear infection
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 110
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 17: Respiratory Infections
ORGANISM
INFLUENZA
TYPE A or B
SYMPTOMS
MODE OF
TRANSMISSION
INCUBATION
PERIOD
PERIOD OF
COMMUNICABILITY
Sudden onset of
respiratory illness
with fever and cough
and with one or more
of the following: sore
throat, athralgia
(painful joints),
myalgia (muscle
pain), runny nose,
headache, prostration
Person to person by
droplets or direct
contact with articles
recently
contaminated with
respiratory
secretions.
1 to 4 days
Adults: Usually 24
hours prior to
symptoms and up to 4
days after clinical
onset
Pediatric &
Immunocompromised: Usually 24
hours prior to
symptoms and up to 7
days after clinical
onset
Note: Fever may not
be prominent in those
>65 years or in
paediatric populations
or those who are
immunocompromised
In children under 5,
gastrointestinal
symptoms may also
be present
RESPIRATORY
SYNCYTIAL
VIRUS (RSV)
Similar to common
cold symptoms;
usually mild but can
be moderate to
severe.
Severe lower
respiratory tract
disease can occur in
the elderly.
RESTRICTIONS
Precautions:
Droplet
Cases should
remain on
precautions until
they are over the
acute illness and
have been afebrile
for 48 hours
(minimum of 5 days
from onset of acute
illness).
Unit restrictions for
an influenza
outbreak remain in
place for 6 days
after onset of
symptoms in the last
case.
Person to person
usually by direct or
close contact with
contaminated
secretions which
may involve droplets
or fomites.
2 to 8 days,
average 4 to 6
days
Period of viral
shedding is usually
from 3 to 8 days but
may be longer in
pediatric and those
who are
immunocompromised.
Virus may live on
environmental
surfaces for many
hours and for a halfhour or more on
hands.
Precautions:
Adults: Droplet
precautions
Pediatrics:
Droplet
precautions while
symptomatic
In pediatric settings,
unit restrictions may
be recommended by
Infection Prevention
and Control.
Cases should
remain on
precautions until
they are over the
acute illness.
PARAINFLUENZA
Type 1, 2, 3
Similar to common
cold symptoms. Can
also cause serious
lower respiratory tract
disease with repeat
infection (e.g.
pneumonia,
bronchitis, and
bronchiolitis) in the
elderly
Person to person
through direct
contact with infected
persons or exposure
to respiratory
secretions on
contaminated
surfaces or objects.
2 to 6 days
Varies with different
types.
Adults: Droplet
precautions
Pediatrics:
Droplet and
contact
precautions while
symptomatic
In pediatric settings,
unit restrictions may
be recommended by
Infection Prevention
and Control.
Cases should
remain on
precautions until
they are over the
acute illness.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 111
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
ORGANISM
ADENOVIRUS
SYMPTOMS
Similar to common
cold symptoms;
usually mild but can
be moderate to
severe.
MODE OF
TRANSMISSION
INCUBATION
PERIOD
Person to person
through direct
contact with infected
persons or exposure
to respiratory
secretions on
contaminated
surfaces or objects.
2 to 14 days
PERIOD OF
COMMUNICABILITY
While symptomatic.
RESTRICTIONS
Adults: Droplet
precautions
Pediatrics:
Droplet
precautions while
symptomatic
In pediatric settings,
unit restrictions may
be recommended by
Infection Prevention
and Control.
Cases should
remain on
precautions until
they are over the
acute illness.
HUMAN METAPNEUMOVIRUS
Similar to common
cold symptoms;
usually mild but can
be moderate to
severe.
Note: unlike
influenza,
patients/residents
usually maintain a
normal appetite.
Person to person
through direct
contact with infected
persons or exposure
to respiratory
secretions on
contaminated
surfaces or objects.
2 to 8 days
While symptomatic
Adults: Droplet
precautions
Pediatrics:
Droplet and
Contact
Precautions while
symptomatic
In pediatric settings,
unit restrictions may
be recommended by
Infection Prevention
and Control.
Cases should
remain on
precautions until
they are over the
acute illness, for a
minimum of 5 days.
Reference: John Hopkins University, Infection Prevention Guidelines for Healthcare Facilities with Limited Resources.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 112
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 18: Case Definition for ILI and an ILI Outbreak
Influenza-like Illness (ILI) Case Definition
Influenza like illness (ILI)
New or worsening cough and Fever
more of the following:
sore throat
athralgia (painful joints)
myalgia (muscle pain)
runny nose
headache
prostration
18
and one or
*Temp >38 or fever that is abnormal for that
individual. Temp <35.6 or >37.4 may be indicative of
health conditions or medical therapy such as use of
anti-inflammatory medications, or corticosteroids etc.
Temp > 38 may not always be present in infected
elderly persons. Subjective report of fever may be
sufficient in some cases.
ILI Outbreak Suspected
Within a LTCF, or a geographic area of an acute care
setting (e.g. floor, unit), the occurrence of 2 or more
symptomatic cases among patients, residents,
clients or staff within 1 week.
Note: ILI outbreak definition primarily applies to
LTCF settings as outbreaks in Acute Care settings
may only be identified in long stay units (e.g.
psychiatry, rehab, or transitional care units).
Symptomatic staff cases must have worked within the
facility or area during the 3 days prior to onset of
symptoms (i.e. during their incubation period).
3. ILI Outbreak Management
All ILI illness is to be treated as if it is Influenza A or B until proven otherwise. Once influenza
is ruled out it is quite possible that Infection Prevention and Control will require all the
following restrictions to remain in place save for those that are described for unvaccinated
staff. Always consult with Infection Prevention and Control to determine what precautions or
restrictions are required.
Practices and Precautions
Routine practices are used for the care of all patients/residents at ALL times.
Influenza can be spread by contact and droplet routes,
consequently, droplet precautions are required.
Droplet precautions include:
Thorough hand washing before and after any patient contact
Wearing of a gown and gloves
Surgical grade mask with attached visor or face shield
Appropriate hand washing while removing protective attire. This is important as
contamination from used attire may occur during removal
18
Note: BCCDC/BC Facility Influenza Immunization Policy: October 18, 2010
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 113
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Room/Unit Closures
The Infection Prevention and Control Team in collaboration with the Clinical
Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care and members of the Outbreak Management Team will
determine room and unit closures.
Patient Line Listings
Infection Prevention and Control requires a daily completion of line listings.
It is the responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to
ensure that the line listings are filled out completely at the beginning of each day, and
submitted to the Infection Control Practitioner by 1000 hrs, by either fax or email as agreed.
Information required includes:
Identification of the unit
Date of completion
Contact person and details
Patient information
Name
Date of birth
Room number
Symptoms, and onset date
Specimens sent
Influenza immunization information
Line listing paperwork should be kept up to date and be available within the affected area,
and faxed/emailed daily to identify any new cases, and current symptom status of all
patients/residents affected. The reporting period is 0700 hrs the previous day to 0700 hrs of
day of faxing/emailing. If there are no new cases within a 24 hour period, this should be
stated on the line listing.
Discontinue daily faxing/emailing of line listings only when instructed by the Infection Control
Practitioner.
Staff Line Listings
Occupational Health & Safety requires daily completion of staff line listings. It is the
responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to ensure the
following information is completed each day, and forwarded to Occupational Health & Safety:
Identification of the unit
Date of completion
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 114
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Contact person and details
Staff details
Full name
Telephone number
Date last worked
Symptoms and onset date
Number of shifts missed
Specimen information
Influenza immunization information.
Discontinue daily faxing/emailing of line listings only when instructed by Occupational Health
& Safety.
Lost Bed Days
It is the responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to
ensure that the bed days lost is recorded at the beginning of each period (0700-0700).
Restrictions on Patient Activities
Patients/residents symptomatic with a respiratory illness should be restricted to their room, on
droplet precautions for a minimum of five (5) days after the start of the illness, or until the
symptoms are no longer present, whichever time period is longer.
All group activities will be cancelled during the course of the outbreak.
Patients/residents may be transferred to other healthcare facilities for a higher level of care
(e.g. Emergency), should their condition require and with communication with that unit/facility.
The transport company and receiving facility must be notified of the precautions required.
The patient must wear a mask for transport. The Infection Prevention and Control Team
should also be informed of the transfer.
Any offsite appointments are discouraged, unless absolutely necessary. Where necessary,
the receiving department or facility is to be notified beforehand. The patient must wear a
mask, and the transport company and receiving facility must be notified of precautions
required.
Working Restrictions for Asymptomatic Healthcare Workers
Working Restrictions for Asymptomatic Staff, immediately following the identification of the
outbreak:
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 115
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Working on the Outbreak Unit
(VIHA policy No. 5.8.6PR, Influenza Prevention Program Procedure)
Unvaccinated staff are subject to exclusion from work within the outbreak facility or
reassignment until the outbreak is declared over. An exception to exclusion of unvaccinated
staff may be made if the unvaccinated staff take antiviral medication as prescribed and the
antiviral medication is continued until the outbreak is declared over. These workers must be
alert to the signs and symptoms of influenza, particularly in the first two (2) days after starting
antiviral prophylaxis, and should be excluded from the patient care environment should they
develop symptoms19.
During an outbreak of laboratory confirmed influenza20, unvaccinated healthcare workers or
those vaccinated within two (2) weeks of the onset of outbreak21 must obtain antiviral
medication, if they are to work on the outbreak unit.
Working on a Non-Outbreak Unit
Asymptomatic healthcare workers, who are not vaccinated for influenza and have worked on
an outbreak unit within three (3) days of the outbreak declaration, will be unable to work on
another unit/facility for three (3) days after the last shift they worked on that unit. This is to
ensure that they remain free from infection following their last exposure. Once the three days
has lapsed, and if they remain without symptoms, they may work on a non-outbreak unit or
facility. This includes casual staff who work in several areas.
Working Restrictions for Symptomatic Healthcare Workers
All symptomatic staff (including students and physicians) must remain off work for a minimum
of five (5) days after onset of illness or until asymptomatic, whichever is the longer time
period.
Students
Students on healthcare worker programs22 will be permitted to attend outbreak units, if they
have previously received instruction on Infection Prevention and Control principles. The
students and Educational Facility Instructor must abide by the same requirements for vaccine
and/or antiviral medication, and the same work restrictions as those of all other healthcare
workers. The Educational Facility Instructor is responsible to provide completed student
19
Unvaccinated staff can use the form letter ―Family Physicians ordering Health Care Worker Anti-viral
Medication‖ to obtain prophylactic medication. Note: the cost of antiviral medication is not covered by the
employer.
20
If the presentation meets the outbreak definition for ILI then one should assume it is influenza, until proven
otherwise by the MHO or IPCT
21
Those considered not protected at the time the outbreak commences. Vaccinated staff should discuss with
Occupational Health & Safety about when they can discontinue taking prophylactic medication.
22
This includes all professions of caregivers, including medical students
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 116
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
vaccination lists to Occupational Health & Safety and to ensure student compliance with
healthcare worker restrictions.
Visitors/ Volunteers
Visitation to an outbreak unit should be restricted to 2 visitors per patient at any one time
during scheduled visitation hours. Patients/residents should be reviewed and
visitors/volunteers determined on an individual basis, considering the needs and medical
condition of the patient. Staff must be consistent with their approach to facility visitation
throughout the outbreak.
Visitors/volunteers choosing to enter the facility must be free of symptoms of illness, and
encouraged to be vaccinated. However, it must be noted that maximum protection takes at
least 2 weeks from vaccination. Visitor/volunteers must be educated in the correct procedure
for hand hygiene and on the correct use of PPE if required. Visitors/volunteers will not visit
other patients/residents/patient rooms, must not visit public areas within the facility (unit
kitchen, cafeteria, shops/kiosks in main entrance etc.) and SHALL NOT use the
patient/resident bathroom.
It is important to consider the needs of the patients/residents and possible staffing shortages,
and weigh these against the concern about community spread of the disease.
Meals
Symptomatic patients/residents should dine in their room with tray service and be restricted
from the dining room and communal activities involving food preparation.
The trays are managed according to direction for individuals on droplet precautions.
Pets
No pets are allowed on affected units.
Housekeeping
For ILI, routine cleaning is required. Attention to detail must be given, especially with
horizontal surfaces and bedside curtains (which must be changed on discharge of the patient
or discontinuation of precautions). Other housekeeping requirements may also be requested.
See also the Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology table.
Linen
No special handling/cleaning of linen is required.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 117
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Collection and Transportation of Nasopharyngeal Swabs
Specimen results directly impact outbreak management strategies for outbreaks of ILI.
Take samples from residents who are newly symptomatic (within 72 hours) or as directed.
Before performing any nasopharyngeal swab, ensure there are no contraindications (e.g.
facial surgery or trauma).
Collect a nasopharyngeal swab from newly symptomatic patients/residents, preferably within
24–72 hours of onset of symptoms (see directions below).
Specimens must be transported directly to the laboratory as soon as possible. Using
established methods for transporting STAT laboratory specimens (i.e. with a cold pack).
Return samples to the laboratory, either by courier during regular business hours or by taxi
after hours and on weekends. The laboratory covers cost of transportation of specimens back
to a VIHA laboratory. They will provide instruction on the process at the time.
Purpose: This procedure describes how to collect a nasopharyngeal swab for influenza
testing.
Collect specimens from patient presenting with Influenza like illness within 72 hours of
onset of symptoms
Routine diagnostic swabs in transport media are NOT acceptable
Calcium alginate swabs used for Bordetella pertussis are NOT acceptable. Residues
present in the swabs may inhibit PCR assays
Nasopharyngeal swabs are available from the Microbiology Laboratory at RJH, NRGH,
CRH, and from the Laboratory at CDH, VGH, SPH, LMH, WCGH, and SJGH
Supplies
Obtain an ‗Influenza Outbreak kit‘ from the Laboratory
Flocked viral swab with Viral transport media (COPAN Red Top)
VIHA inpatient Microbiology requisition
If not available, use Herpes viral swab with viral transport media (Blue Top)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 118
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Procedure
1
Explain procedure to the patient.
2
Protect yourself (fluid resistant mask with visor, gloves and disposable gown).
3
If the patient has a lot of mucous, ask them to use a tissue to gently blow their nose
prior to specimen collection.
·
Influenza is found in the cells that line the nasopharynx, not in the mucous
4
With head supported, push the tip of
the nose upwards. Insert the swab
backwards and downwards to a depth
of 2-4 cm into one nostril. Rotate the
swab gently for 5-10seconds.
5
Place the swab into the virus transport media, snap off the top of swab, tighten cap
securely.
6
Label container with sample type and a minimum of two patient identifiers: First/Last
Name, DOB, PHN, or use patient label with bar graph demographics label.
7
Instruct the patient to use a tissue to contain cough and mucous.
·
Provide hand hygiene for the patient after the procedure
References:
1. BCCDC H1N1 Specimen Collection Guidelines.
2. Vancouver Coastal Health, Influenza-like Illness Outbreak – Specimen Collection.
Staff will obtain an ‗Influenza outbreak kit‘ from the laboratory which will include appropriate
swabs and requisition forms.
Please ensure that you include the facility and relevant outbreak unit on the requisition.
This will ensure the test is done promptly and correctly reported.
Continue collecting specimens from newly symptomatic patients/residents until the laboratory
confirms the organism or you are instructed to stop by the Infection Prevention and Control
Team, Public Health, Medical Health Officer, Microbiologist or Infectious Disease/Control
Physician.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 119
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Prophylaxis for Laboratory Confirmed Influenza
Prophylaxis is the prevention of a disease (in this case influenza) through the use of
medication. As the type of anti-viral medication used varies based on the strain of influenza
and patterns of organism resistance, it is important that the prophylaxis used is the one
recommended by the Medical Health Officer during the current influenza season. Check the
protocol to ensure that it contains this year‘s date. Also, as patients/residents‘ kidney function
may change, it is important that both the Physician‘s prepared order form and the patient‘s
creatinine levels are updated annually.
C.
Gastrointestinal Illness (GI) Outbreaks
1. Introduction
Infectious gastrointestinal (GI) illness or gastroenteritis (―gastro‖) can be associated with a
high incidence of morbidity and mortality. Many of these infections are attributable to
Norovirus (previously known as Norwalk-like virus). Norovirus is extremely communicable
and outbreaks are common. Outbreaks can present in sporadic episodes, or as intensely
concentrated events occurring all at once. Attack rates can be quite high (> 50%) in both staff
and patients/residents.
Symptoms of Gastroenteritis include any combination of nausea, vomiting, diarrhea, and/or
abdominal pain, which may be accompanied by myalgia, headache, low-grade fever, and
malaise. Although most gastroenteritis cases are mild and self-limiting, serious dehydration
and/or aspiration pneumonia secondary to emesis can occur in debilitated individuals.
Transmission usually occurs via the fecal/oral or vomitus/oral route, but can also include
fomite (objects or environmental surfaces) or droplet spread.
2. Confirming a GI Outbreak
Outbreaks of diarrhea in hospitals, nursing homes and NICUs have been associated with a
wide variety of organisms including salmonella, shigella, Clostridium difficile, vibrio (cholera),
Staphylococcus aureus, cryptosporidium, rotavirus and other enteroviruses. Some of the most
common bacterial and viral agents causing infectious diarrhea, their incubation period and
most prominent clinical characteristics are listed in the Table below — Common Bacterial and
Viral Causes of Gastroenteritis.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 120
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Table 19: Common Bacterial and Viral Causes of Gastroenteritis
Organism name
Description
Salmonella
(salmonellosis)
Produces fever, nausea and vomiting followed by diarrhea that frequently contains
mucus (whitish and stringy), but rarely blood, in stools. The incubation period is
less than 72 hours (3 days) when large doses of organisms are eaten in
contaminated food or drinks. Outbreaks among children, however, are commonly
the results of contact transmission, and about 50% of exposed infants will develop
illness once a case is introduced in a nursery. Adults, on the other hand, usually
get salmonellosis from contaminated food, drinks or inadequately cleaned and
disinfected medical instruments such as endoscopes. Once several
patients/residents or staff are infected, transmission by contact to new susceptibles
may be very rapid. Salmonellosis is a common cause of infectious diarrhea,
accounting for more than 50% of all diarrhea outbreaks in nursing homes in which
the causative agent was identified (Levine et al 1991). Control of outbreaks may be
difficult; some nurseries or units have had to restrict new admissions. Safe food
handling is essential for prevention, especially raw (uncooked) eggs or egg
products (e.g.homemade mayonnaise or tartar sauce). Antibiotic treatment
prolongs the time the infected person may carry the organism in her/his GI system,
but antibiotic treatment may be necessary for septic or severely ill
patients/residents.
Shigella (shigellosis)
Produces rapid onset of diarrhea, with stools containing mucus and often blood.
Infected persons are often more sick than is typical for other infecting agents. The
incubation period is 1–6 days, and the usual source is fecal/oral transmission from
acutely infected patients/residents. Outbreaks are less common than with
salmonella or viral agents, and patients/residents shed the organisms only for a
short period after becoming symptomatic.
Clostridium difficile
(formerly called
antibiotic-resistant
diarrhea or
pseudomembranous
colitis)
Has increasingly become an important cause of diarrhea. It may be the cause of
nearly half of all cases of nosocomial diarrhea in adult hospitalized
patients/residents. The diarrhea ranges from mild and self-limiting to severe
pseudomembranous colitis, which can be fatal. Because C. difficile is present in
the stools of infants and preschool children, colonization without clinical disease
apparently occurs. Its presence in the GI tract gradually decreases with age. In
addition, C. difficile may become endemic in the nursery and other high-risk units.
No nosocomial outbreaks have been associated with food borne transmission,
suggesting that contact transmission from contaminated articles or the hands of
staff is responsible. For example, one report noted that when culture-negative
patients/residents were placed in a hospital room currently or previously occupied
by a person with C.difficile diarrhea, they were more likely to develop this type of
diarrhea than patients/residents placed in rooms where no patient had had C.
difficile diarrhea. This suggests the organism can persist on inanimate articles (e.g.
lamps, door handles or bed rails) for some time unless rooms are thoroughly
cleaned between patients/residents.
Strains that cause acute diarrhea have not been reported to be nosocomially
transmitted. Toxic strains have been transmitted in restaurants from contaminated
meat that was not cooked sufficiently to kill the organisms and could be a problem
in healthcare facilities that prepare their own meals from raw meat.
Escherichia coli
Vibrio cholerae
Subgroups produce acute, severe diarrheal disease characterized by local
outbreaks, widespread epidemics and occasional individual outbreaks. Cholera is
usually associated with contaminated water sources.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 121
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Organism name
Rotavirus
Description
Cause sudden onset of vomiting and diarrhea within 48–72 hours
(2–3 days) after exposure. Fever and upper respiratory symptoms are present in
about half the cases. In addition the virus may be present in the sputum or
secretions for several days. This may account for the extremely rapid transmission
and seasonal peak in infections during winter. Symptoms subside in a few days,
but the stool may contain virus for up to 2 weeks. Rotaviruses are the most
common cause of diarrhea in children under five. Because it is highly infectious,
during nursery outbreaks nearly all infants will become infected. Like C. difficile,
the virus survives well on inanimate surfaces and may become endemic in
hospitals.
Reference: John Hopkins University, Infection Prevention Guidelines for Healthcare Facilities with Limited
Resources
Table 20: Gastrointestinal Illness Case Definition
Gastrointestinal Illness (GI) Case Definition
Norovirus Like Illness:
A resident or healthcare worker experiencing sudden
unexplained vomiting or diarrhea in the absence of
a functional cause. Diarrhea is considered two or
more stools greater than the number normally
experienced in a day, and in the absence of laxatives
23
or other bowel stimulating products . Diarrhea
should be liquid enough to take the shape of the
container.
GI Outbreak Suspected if:
An outbreak should be suspected if the following
25
occurs on a designated geographical unit :
The onset among patients/residents and/or staff
of 3 or more symptomatic cases of gastroenteritis
within a 4 day period.
26
Cases must be confirmed with the Infection
Prevention and Control Team. Once they are
confirmed and the number of cases within the
correct time period validated, an outbreak will be
declared and restrictions imposed.
Note: To be defined as a case, the person must
have been present in the facility during the period
of time it takes to incubate the disease. If a staff
member has not been in the facility within the past 3
days, even if they have gastro symptoms, they do
not qualify as a Norovirus case for the purposes of
24
facility tracking . They may have Norovirus, but it
would be considered a ―community‖, not ―workplace‖,
associated case.
3. GI Outbreak Management
All GI illness is to be treated as if it is Norovirus until proven otherwise. Once Norovirus is
ruled out it is quite possible that Infection Prevention and Control may modify some of the
23
Although antibiotics can cause diarrhea also, gastroenteritis should be suspected, especially once antibiotic associated diarrhea is
excluded.
24
This person may be the index case or initiator of an outbreak and their information should be communicated to the Infection Prevention
and Control/ Public Health Lead and Employee Occupational Health & Safety or staffing person.
25
Outbreak Unit designation varies based on the design and layout of the physical structure. The boundaries of the Outbreak Unit will be
established by the Outbreak Lead/Medical Lead in collaboration with the Responsible Physician and the facility administrator.
26
Cases must meet the case definition and then the number of cases must be adequate to meet the outbreak definition.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 122
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
restrictions/precautions in place. Always consult with the Infection Prevention and Control
Team to determine what actions are required.
Practices and Precautions
Routine practices are used for the care of all patients/residents at all times.
Norovirus can be spread by contact and droplet routes, consequently
Droplet Precautions are required for vomiting and handling body fluids only.
Droplet precautions include:
Thorough hand washing before and after any patient contact
Wearing of a gown and gloves
Surgical grade mask with attached visor or face shield
Appropriate hand washing while removing protective attire. This is important as
contamination from used attire may occur during removal
Where there is explosive diarrhea and vomit, the
wearing of a fluid repellent gown is required
Room/Unit Closures
The Infection Prevention and Control Team in collaboration with the Clinical
Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care and members of the Outbreak Management Team will
determine room and unit closures.
Patient Line Listings
Infection Prevention and Control requires a daily completion of line listings
It is the responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to
ensure that the line listings are filled out completely at the beginning of each day, and
submitted to the Infection Control Practitioner by 1000hrs, by either fax or email as agreed.
Information required includes:
Identification of the unit
Date of completion
Contact person and details
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 123
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Patient information
Name
Date of birth
Room number
Symptoms, and onset date
Specimens sent
Line listing paperwork should be kept up to date and be available within the affected area,
and faxed/emailed daily to identify any new cases, and current symptom status of all
patients/residents affected. The reporting period is 0700 hrs the previous day to 0700 hrs of
day of faxing/ emailing. If there are no new cases within a 24 hour period, this should be
stated on the line listing.
Discontinue daily faxing/emailing of line listings only when instructed by the Infection Control
Practitioner.
Staff Line Listings
Occupational Health & Safety requires daily completion of staff line listings. It is the
responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to ensure the
following information is completed each day, and forwarded to Occupational Health & Safety:
Identification of the unit
Date of completion
Contact person and details
Staff details
Full name
Telephone number
Date last worked
Symptoms and onset date
Number of shifts missed
Specimen information
Discontinue daily faxing/emailing of line listings only when instructed by Occupational Health
& Safety.
Lost Bed Days
It is the responsibility of the Clinical Coordinator/Manager of Patient Care (or designate) to
ensure that the bed days lost is recorded at the beginning of each period (0700-0700).
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 124
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Restrictions on Patient Activities
Patients/residents symptomatic for a GI illness should remain in their room on droplet
precautions for a minimum of 2 days (48 hours) after symptoms have ended, unless going
off the unit for tests which are in the interests of the patient‘s well being (however, if the test or
treatment can be provided in the room this should be the first consideration).
These patients/residents should dine in their room with tray service and not attend communal
activities/dining room. If the person shares a room with someone who is not yet symptomatic,
a commode or alternate unshared toilet facility should be provided to prevent further crosscontamination. Patients/residents should be reminded about, and assisted with hand
washing if necessary.
Note: Norovirus can appear to ―relapse‖ frequently, i.e. experience onset of gastroenteritis
symptoms after being asymptomatic for 24 – 48 hours. This relapse is likely due to
malabsorption following infection, rather than a recurrence or reinfection of Norovirus. These
patients/residents should be isolated again until they are symptom free for 48 hours, as cross
infection may still occur. The recurrence of symptoms should be noted on the line listing.
All group activities will be cancelled during the course of the outbreak.
Patients/residents may be transferred to other healthcare facilities for a higher level of care
(e.g. Emergency), should their condition require and with communication with that unit/facility.
The transport company and receiving facility must be notified of the precautions required.
The Infection Prevention and Control Team should also be informed of the transfer.
Offsite appointments are discouraged, unless absolutely necessary. Where necessary, the
receiving department or facility is to be notified beforehand. The transport company and
receiving facility must be notified of precautions required.
Working Restrictions for Staff
Working Restrictions for Staff, please review the GI/Norovirus Algorithm for Staff on the
Infection Prevention and Control internal web site. This algorithm covers information on:
Working on the Outbreak Unit
Working on a Non-Outbreak Unit
Symptomatic Healthcare Workers
Students
Students of healthcare worker programs27 will be permitted to attend outbreak units, if they
have previously received instruction on Infection Prevention and Control practices. The
students and Educational Facility Instructor must abide by the same work restrictions as those
of all other healthcare workers set out in the GI/Norovirus Algorithm for Staff. The
27
This includes all professions of caregivers, including medical students
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 125
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Educational Facility Instructor is responsible for ensuring student compliance with healthcare
worker restrictions.
Visitors/ Volunteers
Visitation to an outbreak unit should be restricted to 2 visitors per patient at any one time,
during scheduled visitation hours. Patients/residents should be reviewed and
visitors/volunteers determined on an individual basis, considering the needs and medical
condition of the patient. Staff must be consistent with their approach to facility visitation
throughout the outbreak.
Visitors/volunteers choosing to enter the facility must be symptom free of any communicable
illness (respiratory illness, diarrhea/vomiting, rash, etc). Visitor/volunteers must be educated
in the correct procedure for hand hygiene and on the correct use of PPE if required.
Visitors/volunteers will not visit other patients/residents/patient rooms, must not visit public
areas within the facility (unit kitchen, cafeteria, shops/kiosks in main entrance etc.) and
SHALL NOT use the patient/resident bathroom.
It is important to consider the needs of the patients/residents and possible staffing shortages,
and weigh these against the concern about community spread of the disease.
Meals
Symptomatic patients/residents should dine in their room with tray service and be restricted
from the dining room and communal activities involving food preparation.
The trays are managed according to direction for individuals on droplet precautions.
Pets
No pets are allowed on affected units.
Housekeeping
During a GI outbreak, units must be cleaned using the twice daily clean, and two step
discharge clean. Attention during cleaning must be given to frequent-touch areas, specifically
horizontal surfaces and bathrooms. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.
A thorough clean of the unit following a GI outbreak should not begin until 4 days (96 hours)
following the cessation of symptoms.
Linen
No special handling/cleaning of linen is required.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 126
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Collection and Transportation of Stool Specimens
Management strategies for outbreaks of gastrointestinal illness are not dependent on
laboratory confirmation. However, it is valuable to collect stool specimens from cases during
outbreaks to try to identify the etiology, if possible.
As directed by Outbreak Lead/Medical Lead, collect stool specimens from patients/residents
that are acutely ill with GI symptoms, preferably within 24-48 hours of onset of symptoms.
Collect one stool specimen from up to 6 symptomatic patients/residents. This number of
specimens is usually sufficient to determine the etiology of the outbreak.
Specimens must be transported to the laboratory as soon as possible using established
methods for transporting STAT laboratory specimens.
Obtaining An Outbreak Number
A unique outbreak identifier number is assigned to each specific GI outbreak. Contact the
Infection Prevention and Control Team to get your number.
How To Collect A Stool Specimen
Gather supplies including a dry specimen container and a clean tongue depressor or
plastic spoon
Pre-label specimen container accurately including patient information and date of
collection
Ensure Outbreak Number is on the requisition
Perform hand hygiene and don appropriate PPE
Scoop the specimen into the container with a disposable tongue depressor or plastic
spoon
Fill the container with stool up to one third or approximately one-tablespoon full
Keep the outside of the container clean, screw the lid tightly onto the plastic container
If possible, have a second person waiting outside the room holding open a biohazard bag
to drop the specimen container into. Have the second person seal the bag
Remove PPE appropriately and perform hand hygiene
Send the specimen and the requisition to the laboratory in a biohazard bag marked
―STAT‖
Note: only stool specimens will be tested. Emesis is no longer acceptable as a suitable
specimen for confirmation of GI.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 127
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 9: Requisition Form for GI Testing
Under examination required, check  Other, and write ―Norovirus PCR‖
One BCCDC virus isolation requisition must be completed for each specimen.
Also include:
Facility
From Outbreak Unit_________(state Unit)
Patient identifiers
Facility contact person
This will ensure the test is done promptly and correctly reported.
Continue collecting specimens from newly symptomatic patients/residents until the laboratory
confirms the organism or you are instructed to stop by the Infection Prevention and Control
Team/Public Health, Medical Health Officer, Microbiologist or Infectious Disease/Control
Physician.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 128
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
D.
Outbreaks Caused by Other Organisms
1. Clostridium Difficile Outbreak
Clostridium difficile illness (CDI) should be considered when a patient experiences sudden
unexplained diarrhea in the absence of a functional cause.
The case definition for CDI is:
Acute onset of diarrhea (3 or more loose stools within a 24 hr period) without another
etiology (diarrhea should be liquid enough to take the shape of the container).
And one or more of the following
Laboratory confirmation (positive toxin), or
Diagnosis of typical pseudo-membranes on sigmoidoscopy or colonoscopy or
histological/pathological diagnosis of CDI, or
Diagnosis of toxic megacolon.
It is assumed that any stool sent to the laboratory for CDI testing is from a patient that has
had at least 3 episodes of loose stools in a 24 hour period. It is accepted that the
surveillance protocol may overestimate the number of cases as some patients/residents
may have had only one or two loose stools prior to a specimen being collected.
Confirming a CDI Outbreak
The outbreak definition for CDI is:
3 or more cases who meet the above case definition within a defined geographical
area and are found to be hospital acquired on the same unit (i.e. does not include
community acquired cases or those readmitted or transferred from a different unit).
The Infection Prevention and Control Team will review and validate that an outbreak exists.
Laboratory samples
Stool that is liquid enough to assume the shape of the container is the acceptable specimen
and must be specifically requisitioned for CDI testing.
If the results of the test are ―Antigen Positive‖ and ―Toxin Negative‖ and symptoms persist,
another specimen should be sent for CDI testing.
Send repeat samples only on patients/residents that meet the definition of relapse or
reinfection (based on a symptom-free interval). Relapse or reinfection is defined as a
reoccurrence of symptoms within 30 days of a previous diagnosed cases of CDI.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 129
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Testing for cure is not required.
2. Work Restrictions
There are no staff work restrictions associated with a CDI outbreak.
Practices and Precautions
Contact precautions in private room or cohorting with other confirmed cases
Emphasize the importance of hand washing for patients/residents, staff and visitors.
ABHRs are less effective for killing C. difficile spores; hand washing must be
encouraged using a neutral soap and water
Twice daily cleaning and 2 step discharge cleans are required in any rooms with
affected patients/residents. Attention is required especially to frequent touch areas
and bathrooms/toilet facilities
3. Scabies
Definitions
Clinical features of infestation
skin penetration visible as papules or vesicles
burrows formed by mites under the skin are visible as linear tracts
lesions are seen most frequently in inter-digital spaces, anterior surfaces of wrists and
ankles, axillae, folds of skin, breasts, genitalia, belt-line and abdomen. Infants may
have lesions of the head, neck, palms and soles of the feet
itching does not always occur with a primary infestation, but when it does it is most
intense at night
itching may continue for approximately 6 weeks after treatment. This does not mean
treatment was not successful
Suspected case
Patient has the above clinical features of scabies infestation
Clinically diagnosed case
Patient has the above clinical features of scabies but skin scraping does not positively
confirm the presence of scabies
Confirmed case
Patient with skin scraping showing mites, eggs or fecal pellets, or a written opinion by
a dermatologist based on signs and symptoms
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 130
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Close contact
Unprotected, prolonged, direct contact with skin, clothing or linens of a person with
untreated scabies
Crusted (Norwegian) scabies
Is usually seen in immunocompromised people, this form of scabies is characterized
by widespread, extensive crusting and scaling of the skin. Rash may be present and
on any area of the body and thousands of mites may be present
This form of scabies is highly contagious
An outbreak is considered when:
Two or more patients/residents diagnosed with scabies on one unit within a 2-week
period
or
One patient plus one or more staff members on one unit are diagnosed with
scabies within a 2-week period
Specific Interventions
Validation
The Infection Prevention and Control Team will validate an outbreak and its extent. This
may involve consultation with a dermatologist to attempt to confirm the diagnosis by
obtaining skin scrapings
Assessment of all current patients/residents, staff, volunteers and students on the unit for
symptoms must be carried out prior to administration of treatment or prophylaxis of cases
or contacts. All patients/residents cared for on the unit and staff assigned on the unit in
the previous 6 weeks will be tracked and contacted
Administration will be informed of a suspected outbreak by the Infection Prevention and
Control team
Laboratory Samples
Skin scrapings are obtained by a person trained in collection of the specimen using a kit
requested from the Microbiology Laboratory
Control Measures
Upon validation of an outbreak, the unit will be closed to admissions and transfers.
Discharged patients/residents should be assessed for symptoms and advised of the need
for treatment or prophylaxis
Only patients/residents who have symptoms or have positive skin scrapings need to be
placed on contact precautions until 24 hours after initiation of treatment.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 131
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Patients/residents with Crusted Scabies remain on precautions until symptoms have
abated
Treatment of symptomatic cases and prophylaxis of all contacts (including asymptomatic
patients/residents, healthcare workers, volunteers and visitors) must take place within the
same 24-hour period
Symptomatic Patients/Residents – Treatment
Staff, using contact precautions and working in teams, will bathe and dry
patients/residents, clip the patients/residents‘ fingernails, and clean under their nails.
Examine the scalp for crusted lesions in confirmed cases. Apply medication as ordered
and according to the drug information insert. Simultaneously the patient bed must be
stripped, cleaned and remade and clothing is bagged
In accordance with contact precautions, staff must wear long sleeved gowns and gloves,
which are changed between patients/residents
Follow-up baths to remove medication are done at either 8 or 12 hours after treatment,
dependent on the treatment used. Bed is again stripped and remade
Asymptomatic Patients/Residents – Prophylaxis
Prophylaxis of asymptomatic patients/residents is limited to the involved unit. These
patients/residents receive one application of medication and follow-up bath. Linens and
clothing are changed per routine
Symptomatic Staff – Treatment
Every employee case must be reported to Occupational Health & Safety, who can
facilitate dermatology consultation and staff case management. Staff and students who
have worked on this unit over the previous 6 weeks must be contacted and assessed
Staff diagnosed with scabies are relieved of direct patient contact until 24 hours after
initiation of treatment
Household, sexual and other close contacts (skin to skin contact or sharing clothes or bed
linens) of a staff case should receive treatment (if symptomatic) or prophylaxis during the
same 24-hour period as the staff treatment
Pet prophylaxis is not needed, as animal scabies is a different species
Environment
All linen, towels and clothing used in the previous 4 days should be washed in hot water
(60ºC) and heat dried. Items that cannot be washed in hot water should be stored in a
plastic bag for at least 7 days before washing and reusing
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 132
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
There is no need for special treatment of furniture, mattresses or rugs. General cleaning
and thorough vacuuming is recommended
Asymptomatic Staff, Volunteers and Physicians – Prophylaxis
For staff – apply the medication, and then bath or shower at either 8 or 12 hours,
dependent on the treatment used later as per the medication package information insert
For volunteers/physicians, need for prophylaxis treatment is determined on the amount of
direct contact that the person has with the patient and environment
No special handling of clothing or linens is needed
Family members of asymptomatic staff do not require prophylaxis
Note: If pregnant, or for children under 2 years of age, consult physician prior to treatment
Environmental Cleaning
Special attention should be paid to the items with which infested patients/residents have had
direct skin contact in the previous four days. These include clothing, wheelchair cushions,
shoes, slippers, coats, lap blankets, etc. Items that cannot be washed in hot water (60ºC) or
sent to laundry are placed in a sealed plastic bag for 7 days or dry-cleaned. General cleaning
and thorough vacuuming of furniture is recommended.
Scabies Outbreak Conclusion
The unit may be reopened to admissions and transfers when all patients/residents involved
have received treatment or prophylaxis and follow-up baths. Symptomatic patients/residents
may still be cared for in isolation.
Monitoring continues for at least 6 weeks following last exposure for development of new
cases.
Reference: Scabies Control Guidelines circular #2005: 02, BC Centre for Disease Control February 2005.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 133
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 7: DEPARTMENTAL GUIDELINES
1.
Inpatient Mother and Baby
A.
Routine Practices
Routine practices are to be used with all patients/residents at all times.
The key to implementing routine practices is to assess the risk of transmission of
microorganisms before any interaction with the patient. The elements of routine practices
are:
Risk Assessment
Risk Reduction
Education
Hand hygiene is the single most effective method of reducing cross infection. The healthcare
setting provides an ideal opportunity to educate parents on the importance, methods and
situations for hand hygiene.
B.
Additional Precautions
Additional precautions are required when routine practices are not sufficient to prevent the
transmission of certain microorganisms.
It may be necessary to isolate both mother and baby into a single room. Where this is not
possible, additional precautions can be implemented in a multi-patient room. However, in this
situation it is important to limit the movement of the mother around the room/unit.
Table 21: Common Conditions and Precautions Needed
Note: This list is not exhaustive, but includes conditions of particular importance to this
area (see also Appendix A)
CONDITION
Ophthalmia neonatorum
PRECAUTIONS / PRACTICES
Contact Precautions
Pustules/cellulitis
Toxoplasma, Rubella,
Cytomegalovirus and Herpes
Virus (TORCH) Syndrome
Varicella
Herpes (Non-Genital and Genital)
Routine Practices
Droplet Precautions
Airborne Precautions
See algorithm below
COMMENTS
Until 24 hours of effective
antibiotic therapy
No precautions necessary by the
parents
Between 10–21 days
28
28
Neonates born to mothers with active Varicella should be placed on airborne precautions until 21 days of age (or 28 days if
VZIG is given). If a mother develops chicken pox from 5 days before to 3 days after delivery, consult the physician regarding
the possible administration of VZIG to the neonate. Neonates (up to 2 months of age) of antibody positive mothers, who are
exposed to varicella do not require isolation.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 134
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
C.
Herpes
Figure 10: Precautions Required When Caring for Mother with Non-Genital Herpes
Mother with
Non-Genital Herpes
Lesions
dry / crusted
Lesions
open / weeping
ROUTINE PRACTICES
Good personal
hygiene?
NO
YES
CONTACT PRECAUTIONS

Single room isolation

Instruction regarding
hygiene measures
NO
Can lesions be covered with
dressing or mask?
YES
ROUTINE PRACTICES

Reinforce need to cover
lesions
Figure 11: Precautions Required When Caring for Mother with Genital Herpes
Mother with
Genital Herpes
No open lesions;
No recent positive culture
Lesions present; or
recent positive for HSV
ROUTINE PRACTICES
CONTACT PRECAUTIONS

Single room isolation
1. Staff Precautions
Staff must be free from any transmissible infection. This includes dermatitis, which can be
colonized with microorganisms, and skin cells are readily shed.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 135
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Staff with herpes lesions must not work while they are in the early stages of disease (wet
blistered lesions). Lesions must be dry and scabbed, and preferably covered with a dressing
prior to returning to work.
Information relating to staff immunization can be obtained from Occupational Health & Safety.
Any further advice should be sought from Occupational Health & Safety.
D.
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms
AROs are defined as microorganisms that are resistant to one or more classes of
antimicrobial agents.
a. Methicillin Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA)
b. Vancomycin Resistant Enterococci (VRE)
c. Bacteria containing Extended Spectrum Beta Lactamase (ESBL)
All admissions to the maternity unit must be screened for AROs by completing the ARO
Screening Questionnaire. It is the responsibility of the nurse/midwife completing this
questionnaire to collect the swabs as required. If swabs are required from the mother, a
vaginal swab for MRSA is also required. The vagina is a significant site as a source of
transmission to the newborn.
In the instance that a parent or family member living in the home is identified as having an
ARO, there is a significant risk that the baby will become colonized during their
hospitalization. For this reason, the baby should also be treated as if positive, and
appropriate additional precautions put in place.
E.
Outbreaks
The Infection Prevention and Control Team will investigate all outbreaks in close liaison with
the Clinical coordinator/Clinical Nurse Leader/Unit Manager (Outbreak Team). In order to
bring control, and reduce/prevent further cross infection, it is essential to alert the Infection
Prevention and Control Team as soon as there is any suspicion there could be an outbreak.
An outbreak is defined as the occurrence of two or more related cases of the same infection,
or where the number of infections is greater than would normally be expected.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 136
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2.
Neonatal Intensive Care and Special Care Baby Units
A.
Routine Practices
Due to the vulnerability and increased invasive procedures required, the neonate is at great
risk from acquiring an infection. Routine practices are to be used with all patients/residents at
all times
The key to implementing routine practices is to assess the risk of transmission of
microorganisms before any interaction with the patient. The elements of routine practices
are:
Risk Assessment
Risk Reduction
Education
Hand hygiene is the single most effective method of reducing cross infection. Parents must
be taught and encouraged to perform hand hygiene before any contact with their baby.
B.
Visitors
Parents, visitors or staff believed to be incubating or infectious with a communicable
illness must be restricted from visiting the nursery. Staff should contact Occupational
Health & Safety for further information and advice
Parents, visitors or staff with open skin lesions should be assessed and counseled prior to
having contact with the neonate. Staff should contact Occupational Health & Safety for
further information and advice
Mothers believed to be incubating or infectious with a communicable illness should be
assessed by the physician to confirm prior exposure and advice on where visitation may
occur
All visitors must be discouraged from visiting other parents at their baby‘s cot or incubator
at any time
C.
Additional Precautions
Additional precautions are required when routine practices are not sufficient to prevent the
transmission of certain microorganisms.
It may be necessary to isolate the neonate into a single room. Where this is not possible,
additional precautions can be implemented in a multi-patient room with the use of an
incubator.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 137
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
It is usually not necessary for parents to wear gloves for contact with their baby, but hand
hygiene must precede and follow any contact with the baby. A long sleeved gown should be
worn when additional precautions are required, to prevent contamination of their clothing and
therefore transmission to the environment.
1. Contact Precautions
Contact precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are principally spread
through direct (hands) or indirect (equipment, environmental) contact.
Label the cot, incubator or room with the yellow precautions sign
Gloves and gown are worn for all contact with the neonate and their physical
environment
Ensure the isolation cart is positioned appropriately for easy access to protective
clothing and other equipment, but not in a position where it will become contaminated
Dedicate equipment to the neonate. Where equipment cannot be dedicated, it must be
thoroughly decontaminated after use
Notify housekeeping as special cleaning will be required. See Housekeeping Cleaning
Terminology
2. Droplet Precautions
Droplet precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are transmitted by
aerosol of respiratory secretions, emesis or diarrhea, through forceful expulsion of these body
fluids.
Label the cot, incubator or room with the green precautions sign
Gloves and gown are worn for all contact with the neonate and their physical
environment. A mask with visor may be necessary, particularly if the neonate is not in
an incubator
Ensure the isolation cart is positioned appropriately for easy access to protective
clothing and other equipment, but not in a position where it will become contaminated
Dedicate equipment to the neonate. Where equipment cannot be dedicated, it must be
thoroughly decontaminated after use
Notify housekeeping as special cleaning will be required. See Housekeeping Cleaning
Terminology
3. Airborne Precautions
Airborne precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are transmitted by
way of the respiratory tract.
The neonate is cared for in an isolation room with negative pressure ventilation. The
Infection Prevention and Control Team should be consulted, and will advise where a
negative pressure room is unavailable
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 138
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Label the room with the blue precautions sign
All staff are directed to wear an appropriate mask if susceptible to the confirmed or
suspected infection
Doors to the room must remain closed
Table 22: Common Conditions and Precautions Needed
Note: This list is not exhaustive, but includes conditions of particular importance to this
area (see Appendix A)
CONDITION
Ophthalmia neonatorum
PRECAUTIONS/ PRACTICES
Contact Precautions
Pustules/cellulitis
TORCH Syndrome
Routine Practices
Droplet Precautions
Varicella
Airborne precautions
D.
COMMENTS
Until 24 hours of effective
antibiotic therapy
No precautions necessary by the
parents
Between 10-21 days29
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms
AROs are defined as microorganisms that are resistant to one or more classes of
antimicrobial agents
Examples of Antibiotic Resistant Organisms include:
Methicillin Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA)
Vancomycin Resistant Enterococci (VRE)
Bacteria containing Extended Spectrum Beta Lactamase (ESBL)
All admissions to the Neonatal/Special Care Baby Unit must be screened for AROs by
completing the Neonatal ARO Screening Questionnaire. It is the responsibility of the
nurse/midwife completing this questionnaire to collect the swabs as required.
ESBL is very rare in neonates and therefore screening swabs for these organisms are not
required from the neonate.
In the instance that a parent or family member living in the home are identified as having an
ARO, there is a significant risk that the baby will become colonized during hospitalization. For
this reason, the baby should also be treated as if positive and appropriate additional
precautions put in place.
29
Neonates born to mothers with active Varicella should be placed on airborne precautions until 21 days of age (or 28 if VZIG is given). If a
mother develops chicken pox from 5 days before to 3 days after deliver, consult the physician regarding the possible administration of VZIG
to the neonate. Neonates (up to 2 months of age) of antibody positive mothers, who are exposed to varicella do not require isolation.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 139
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
The parents of the baby being isolated for TORCH syndrome or hepatitis are not required to
wear protective clothing for handling their child, as they have already been exposed and are
therefore either immune or infected. It is still important for parents to wash their hands
following contact to reduce the risk of further contamination of the environment through
contact.
E.
Outbreaks
The Infection Prevention and Control Team will investigate all outbreaks in close liaison with
the Clinical coordinator/Clinical Nurse Leader/Unit Manager (Outbreak Team). In order to
bring control, and reduce/prevent further cross infection, it is essential to alert the Infection
Prevention and Control Team as soon as there is any suspicion there could be an outbreak.
An outbreak is defined as the occurrence of two or more related cases of the same infection,
or where the number of infections is greater than would normally be expected.
3.
Pediatrics
A.
Routine Practices
Due to the vulnerability and increased invasive procedures required, children are at great risk
from acquiring an infection. Routine practices are to be used with all patients/residents at all
times.
The key to implementing routine practices is to assess the risk of transmission of
microorganisms before any interaction with the patient. The elements of Routine Practices
are:
Risk Assessment
Risk Reduction
Education
Hand hygiene is the single most effective method of reducing cross infection. The healthcare
setting provides an ideal opportunity to educate children and their parents/visitors on the
importance, methods and situations for hand hygiene.
B.
Additional Precautions
Additional precautions are required when routine practices are not sufficient to prevent the
transmission of certain microorganisms.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 140
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
The implementation of additional precautions into pediatric units and departments presents
some unique challenges. Unfortunately, it is very difficult to set specific rules as precautions
taken often depend upon the age and developmental stage of the child.
Young children have a limited understanding of infection prevention and control, because it is
difficult for them to comprehend cause and effect relationships between germs and illness.
These children require greater restrictions on their activities, as they cannot be relied upon to
practice routine infection prevention and control practices, such as cough etiquette or hand
hygiene after using the bathroom. It is essential to communicate honestly and openly with
parents, to harness their cooperation and support in limiting the child‘s activities.
Older children understand causality better, and can be provided with factual information.
However, compliance with infection prevention and control principles can still be problematic,
and often requires great skill to encourage the child.
Communication and education of family members and visitors is essential to ensure
compliance with routine practices and any additional precautions implemented. Decisions to
isolate and add precautions must be fully explained to the family, with the underlying rationale
for doing so.
1. Contact Precautions
Contact precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are principally spread
through direct (hands) or indirect (equipment, environmental) contact.
Where possible isolate the child in a single room, or cohort with other children with the same
infectious illness. Where this is not possible:
Precautions should be put in place in a multi-bedded room and the Infection Control
Practitioner informed
Label the room with the yellow precautions sign
Gloves and gown are worn for all contact with the child and their physical environment
Ensure the isolation cart is positioned appropriately for easy access to protective
clothing and other equipment, but not in a position where it will become contaminated
Dedicate equipment to the child. Where equipment cannot be dedicated, it must be
thoroughly decontaminated after use
Notify housekeeping as special cleaning will be required. See Housekeeping Cleaning
Terminology
2. Droplet Precautions
Droplet precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are transmitted by
aerosol of respiratory secretions, emesis or diarrhea, through forceful expulsion of these body
fluids.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 141
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Where possible isolate the child in a single room, or cohort with other children with the
same infectious illness. Where this is not possible, precautions should be put in place
in a multi-bedded room and the Infection Control Practitioner informed
Label the room with the green precautions sign
A mask with visor may be necessary
Ensure the isolation cart is positioned appropriately for easy access to protective
clothing and other equipment, but not in a position where it will become contaminated
Dedicate equipment to the child. Where equipment cannot be dedicated, it must be
thoroughly decontaminated after use
Notify housekeeping as special cleaning will be required. See Housekeeping Cleaning
Terminology
3. Airborne Precautions
Airborne precautions are implemented for pathogenic organisms, which are transmitted by
way of the respiratory tract.
The child is cared for in an isolation room with negative pressure ventilation. The
Infection Prevention and Control Team should be consulted, and will advise where a
negative pressure room is unavailable
Label the room with the blue precautions sign
All staff are directed to wear an appropriate mask if susceptible to the confirmed or
suspected infection
Doors to the room must remain closed
C.
Communicability Periods
Note: this list is not exhaustive, but includes conditions of particular importance to this area
(See Appendix A)
Susceptible Contacts of
From –
(days after first contact)
To – (days after last definitive
contact)
Chickenpox
10 days
21 days (28 days if VZIG given)
Diphtheria
2 days
14 days if no culture or until bacteriology
confirms absence of carrage
Mumps
12 days
25 days
Polio
0 days
When stools negative
Streptococcal Pharyngitis
1 day
1 day (treated)
3 days (untreated)
Rubella (German Measles)
Rubeola (Measles)
Tuberculosis (pulmonary)
14 days
23 days
7 days
18 days
4 weeks
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Until bacteriology confirms absence of
infection
Page 142
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Pertussis (Whooping Cough)
5 days
14 days after last exposure or until cases
and contacts have received a minimum of
14 days course of appropriate antibiotics
Precautions are not required before and after the above established incubation periods.
During the presumed infectious period, elective admission should be avoided.
Patients/residents admitted during these times shall be treated with appropriate precautions.
D.
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms
AROs are defined as microorganisms that are resistant to one or more classes of
antimicrobial agents.
Examples of Antibiotic Resistant Organisms include:
Methicillin Resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA)
Vancomycin Resistant Enterococci (VRE)
Bacteria containing Extended Spectrum Beta Lactamase (ESBL)
All admissions to the Paediatric unit must be screened for AROs by completing the ARO
screening questionnaire. It is the responsibility of the nurse completing this questionnaire to
collect the swabs as required.
In the instance that a parent or family member living in the home are identified as having an
ARO, there is a significant risk that the baby will become colonized during hospitalization. For
this reason, the child should also be treated as if positive and appropriate additional
precautions put in place.
In the instance that a parent (mother, father or mother‘s partner) is identified as having an
ARO, there is a significant risk that the child will become colonized during hospitalization. For
this reason, the child should also be treated as if positive and appropriate additional
precautions put in place.
E.
Outbreaks
The Infection Prevention and Control Team will coordinate all outbreaks in close liaison with
the Clinical coordinator/Clinical Nurse Leader/Unit Manager. In order to bring control, and
reduce/prevent further cross infection, it is essential to alert the Infection Prevention and
Control Team as soon as there is any suspicion there could be an outbreak.
An outbreak is defined as the occurrence of two or more related cases of the same infection,
or where the number of infections is greater than would normally be expected.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 143
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
4.
Infection Prevention and Control Practices for Surgical
Service Areas
A.
Rationale
Surgical procedures are associated with risk of introducing infection to the patient as a result
of disruption of normal host barriers. Hence, use of appropriate sterile technique by all
personnel is necessary to reduce the risk of introducing infection to the patient.
However, given the invasive nature of operative procedures, there is also significant risk of
exposure and contamination of healthcare staff and the environment in surgical care areas by
blood, body fluids and tissue (including airborne skin and other epithelial cells colonized with
microbes) from patients/residents undergoing surgery. Consequently, strict adherence to
infection prevention and control practices is necessary to protect staff and other
patients/residents. This includes following strict aseptic technique, the appropriate use of
PPE, as well as thorough cleaning and disinfection of the surgical environment (from preanaesthetic to operative to post-anaesthetic areas) between patients/residents.
The basic standard of infection prevention and control and housekeeping practices should be
sufficient in most cases to prevent the transmission of infection. This is particularly relevant
for antibiotic resistant organisms (AROs), since a patient‘s colonization status may not be
known at the time of their surgical procedure. Patients/residents who require additional
precautions in the operating room are those who have clinical signs and symptoms consistent
with infection with a communicable pathogen, whether directly related to the nature of the
surgical procedure or not (e.g. a patient with diarrhea undergoing pacemaker implantation), or
who are known to be colonized with a pathogen that represents an increased risk of
transmission (e.g. AROs).
B.
Principles
Routine practices are exercised by all staff at all times.
Additional precautions will be dictated by prior knowledge of ARO colonization status and
patient assessment of risk for transmission of communicable disease (evidence of infection,
whether directly related to the surgical procedure or not).
Only anaesthetic/OR equipment and supplies needed for the surgical procedure are to be
brought into the operating suite. Equipment that cannot be removed should be located as far
from the procedure table as possible. If within a one metre distance, they should be draped
to protect them from splashes. The drape is removed and replaced during post-case
cleaning.
Personal items (e.g. computers, brief cases, backpacks, etc.) are not to be brought into the
operating suite.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 144
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Use of appropriate barrier precautions by staff at all times is essential to protect staff and
reduce risk of communicable disease transmission.
Patient isolation is generally unnecessary and potentially detrimental to patient care.
Cleaning and disinfection must be performed for all cases sufficient to eradicate most
pathogens (including AROs) from the surgical environment and must be performed between
each case. Accelerated hydrogen peroxide (1:16) is the agent advocated for cleaning of all
surgical care areas. This will likely have significant potential impact on flow through the
operating rooms.
Enhanced cleaning (for VRE) or Two-Step cleaning (for diarrheal illnesses) using accelerated
hydrogen peroxide may be necessary in particular instances for patients/residents requiring
Additional Precautions, on the recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control. See
Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology
Where feasible, cases involving patients/residents who require additional precautions should
be booked at the end of the slate. If the case cannot be delayed, thorough cleaning and
disinfection of the surgical care areas must be assured between cases.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 145
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 12: Surgical Booking Procedure
Booking Request
No Infection
ARO- or
unknown
No Infection
ARO+
Infection
ARO+ or ARO-
Airborne
Infection
Only
ARO+ or ARO-
Airborne AND
other infection
Book for
Routine Discharge
Cleaning
Book for
Routine Discharge
Cleaning
Book for Routine
Discharge
Cleaning + Walls
Book Negative
Pressure Room &
Routine Discharge
Cleaning
Book Negative
Pressure Room &
Routine Discharge
Cleaning + Walls
Patient Reassessment for Communicable Disease (Infection) Risk
(Pre-admit Clinic, Anesthesiologist, Surgeon, Admitting Nurse)
No Infection
No Infection
Infection
Contact
Precautions
- Gloves - casual
contact
- Gowns - close
contact
- Hand hygiene
after any contact
Droplet
Precautions
- Gloves & gown
for all contact
- Mask with shield
if within 3 feet
- Hand hygiene
after any contact
Airborne
Precautions
- N95 Mask
- Negative
pressure room
*TB/Chickenpox
ARO+ or ARO-
*TB/Chickenpox &
other infection
Routine
Practices
Contact
Precautions
Contact / Droplet
Precautions
Airborne Precautions
plus Contact
Precautions
(if required)
Airborne AND
Contact / Droplet
Precautions
Routine
Discharge
Cleaning
Routine
Discharge
Cleaning
Routine
Discharge
Cleaning + Walls
Routine
Discharge
Cleaning
Routine
Discharge
Cleaning + Walls
Airborne AND
Contact /
Droplet
Precautions:
- N95 Mask
- Negative air
room
- Gloves & gown
for all contact
- Shield or
protective eye
wear within 3 feet
- Hand hygiene
after any contact
*Most common airborne organisms. Schedule case at end of day or allow an extra 10 minutes for cleaning.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 146
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
When a surgical booking is made, increased risk of communicable disease transmission
should be identified by the booking surgeon (i.e. infection, see the following Table:
Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission).
Table 23: Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission
Determine from the booking surgeon (at time of booking) and patient and/or unit staff
(hospitalized patient) if the patient has:
TB or Chicken Pox
• Airborne Precautions
Fever & Cough
• Droplet Precautions
Skin Infection, open wound, boil or
abscess
• Contact Precautions
Diarrhea in the past 2 days
• Contact Precautions
No risk factors for communicable
disease transmission
• Routine Practices
If on contact precautions, determine from the patient and/or unit staff if the patient has:
C.difficile
VRE
Note: If there is a Norovirus outbreak in the facility/unit from which the patient is coming, check with
Unit Manager/Infection Control Practitioner.
Cases where there is NO known colonization with an ARO and no identified increased risk of
communicable disease transmission (i.e. infection, see Table 21: Assessment for Increased
Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission) may be booked at ANY TIME with direction for
Routine Discharge Cleaning. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology
Cases where there is known colonization with an ARO but no identified increased risk of
communicable disease transmission (i.e. infection, see Table 21: Assessment for Increased
Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission) may be booked at any time with direction for
Routine Discharge cleaning. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology. OR/PAR staff to use
Contact Precautions.
If there is identified increased risk of communicable disease transmission (i.e. infection, see
Table 21: Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission),
determine if the infection is known or thought due to tuberculosis (TB) or chickenpox. If so,
book as an Airborne case at any time in a negative pressure OR suite, with direction for
Routine Discharge Cleaning. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 147
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
If there is an infection other than TB or chickenpox, the case may be booked as a contact or
droplet case at any time with direction for Routine Discharge Cleaning with the addition of wall
surfaces. Additional time for such cleaning to be done (add an approximate additional 10
minutes) should be added. Cases with infections where two-step cleaning is required (i.e.
Norovirus, clostridium difficile, etc.), should be booked at the end of the slate if possible.
Where feasible, it should be recommended that ALL patients/residents have a preoperative
bath or shower with antiseptic soap the night before and the morning of surgery. This is
mandatory for elective cases, but not anticipated to be feasible for non-elective cases.
Chlorhexidine (4%) is the antiseptic agent recommended.
C.
Procedure Pre-Operatively
See also Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission
1. Cases Without Identified Need for Additional Precautions
The patient should have a preoperative bath or shower with antiseptic soap the night before
and the morning of surgery. This is mandatory for elective cases, but not anticipated to be
feasible for non-elective cases. Chlorhexidine (4%) is the antiseptic agent recommended.
All slated Same Day Admit or Daycare patients check in and are prepared in the normal
fashion, including hand hygiene on arrival.
They should be instructed on admission on hand hygiene and instructed to clean toilet
surfaces after personal use with accelerated hydrogen peroxide wipes. For non-elective
cases, if possible, the patient should be instructed to wash hands or use ABHR on arrival to
the preoperative area.
Patients/residents should be assessed for presence of increased risk of communicable
disease transmission (i.e. infection; see Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable
Disease Transmission). If present, follow the appropriate algorithm (see Surgery Booking
Request) The need for additional precautions must be clearly communicated to other staff in
the surgical care areas (OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Routine practices are to be used by all personnel unless otherwise indicated.
Cleaning/disinfection of environmental surfaces in all pre-operative care areas contaminated
or potentially contaminated by the patient should be performed prior to next patient use.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 148
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Cases Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of
Infection
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
The patient should have a preoperative bath or shower with antiseptic soap the night before
and the morning of surgery. This is mandatory for elective cases, but not anticipated for nonelective cases. Chlorhexidine (4%) is the antiseptic agent recommended.
All slated Same Day Admit or Daycare patients check in and are prepared in the normal
fashion, including hand hygiene on arrival.
They should be instructed on admission on hand hygiene and instructed to clean toilet
surfaces after personal use with accelerated hydrogen peroxide wipes. For non-elective
cases, if possible, the patient should be instructed to wash hands or use ABHR on arrival to
the preoperative area.
Patients/residents should be treated with contact precautions when close personal care is
being provided (from pre-anaesthetic to operative to post-anaesthetic areas. The need for
contact precautions must be clearly communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas
(OR and post-anaesthetic area).
The patient chart will be transported in a pillowcase. When removed from the pillowcase, the
chart should be placed on a clean surface away from patient contact surfaces (such as the
bed and any over bed table, etc.). Hand hygiene should be performed before and after
handling the chart. The chart may be returned to the same pillowcase used for transport, as
long as the inside of the pillowcase has not been contaminated.
Patients/residents should be assessed for presence of increased risk of communicable
disease transmission (i.e. infection; see Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable
Disease Transmission). If present, follow the appropriate algorithm (see Surgery Booking
Request); this may require additional precautions. The need for additional precautions must
be clearly communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas (OR and post-anaesthetic
area).
Cleaning/disinfection of environmental surfaces in all pre-operative care areas contaminated
or potentially contaminated by the patient should be performed prior to next patient use.
3. Cases Where Patient has Evidence of Infection: Contact or
Droplet Precautions
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
The patient should have a preoperative bath or shower with antiseptic soap the night before
and the morning of surgery. This is mandatory for elective cases, but not anticipated to be
feasible for non-elective cases. Chlorhexidine (4%) is the antiseptic agent recommended.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 149
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Patients/residents known to have an infection or who are already under additional precautions
should be transferred under contact or droplet precautions directly into the OR or to the OR
holding area (not the pre-operative area) on their bed or stretcher. Cleaning of that
environment may be necessary if there is obvious contamination. If the patient is in the
Emergency Department (ED) and transfer on the ED stretcher is not feasible, if possible, the
patient should be transported on a stretcher from the post-anaesthetic area, brought from the
post-anaesthetic area to ED by the porter.
The patient chart will be transported in a pillowcase. When removed from the pillowcase, the
chart should be placed on a clean surface away from patient contact surfaces (such as the
bed and any over bed table, etc.). Hand hygiene should be performed before and after
handling the chart. The chart may be returned to the same pillowcase used for transport, as
long as the inside of the pillowcase has not been contaminated.
Patients/residents should continue to be treated with contact or droplet precautions when
close personal care is being provided (from pre-anaesthetic to operative to post-anaesthetic
areas). The need for and type of contact or droplet precautions must be clearly
communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas (OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Patients/residents should be assessed for presence of increased risk of communicable
disease transmission (i.e. infection) other than that already identified prior to admission to the
surgical care area; see Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease
Transmission. If present, follow the appropriate algorithm (see Surgery Booking Request).
The need for additional precautions must be clearly communicated to other staff in the
surgical care areas (OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Cleaning of environmental surfaces in all pre-operative care areas contaminated or potentially
contaminated by the patient should be performed prior to next patient use. Where additional
precautions are required, Enhanced cleaning or Two-Step cleaning using accelerated
hydrogen peroxide may be necessary in particular instances for patients/residents requiring
Additional Precautions, on the recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control (see the
Surgical Housekeeping algorithm and Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 150
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Figure 13: Surgical Housekeeping Algorithm
No Infection
ARO+ or ARO-
Cases requiring
Airborne Precautions
Infection Requiring
Contact Precautions
Cases requiring
Droplet Precautions
Routine Discharge Cleaning
with *H2O2 1:16
or
QAC
Routine Discharge Cleaning
with *H2O2 1:16
or
QAC
All horizontal and contact surfaces (both
sides) in pre-anesthetic area, OR &
postoperative area
All horizontal and contact surfaces (both
sides) in pre-anesthetic area, OR &
postoperative area
Cleaning of walls if visibly soiled (OR)
Cleaning of walls (OR)
Cleaning of head space walls and
Change bedside drapes when visibly
soiled (PAR)
Cleaning of head space walls and
Change bedside drapes after patient
(PAR)
Two-Step Cleaning for
- C.difficile
- Norovirus
- Diarrhea
*H2O2=Acclerated Hydrogen Peroxide - Preferred cleaning solution and must be used for VRE.
QAC=Quaternary Ammonium Compound
D.
Procedure in the Operating Room
1. Routine Practices
Routine practices are to be used by all personnel.
All personnel entering and remaining in the OR are to perform hand hygiene (at a minimum)
prior to entering the suite. Hand hygiene must be used before and after contact with the
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 151
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
patients/residents or their environment. Hand hygiene product should be available at point-ofuse for this purpose.
All personnel in the OR must wear a fluid-resistant mask within one metre of any potential
splash/splatter risk. A mask with face shield must be worn when there is risk of splash with
blood or body substances, contaminating mucous membranes, during surgery, placement of
venous lines and intubation.
Gloves must also be worn at all times where there is risk of contact with blood or body
substances (e.g. during intubation). Disposable gloves must be available at point-of-use for
this purpose.
Shoe covers or footwear dedicated to the surgical care area must be worn at all times and
removed prior to leaving the surgical care area followed immediately by hand hygiene.
Only anaesthetic/OR equipment and supplies needed for the surgical procedure are to be
brought into the operating suite. Equipment that cannot be removed should be located as far
from the procedure table as possible. If within a one metre distance, they should be draped
to protect them from splashes. The drape is removed and replaced during post-case
cleaning.
Personal items (i.e. computers, brief cases, backpacks, etc.) are not to be brought into the
operating suite.
Hand hygiene must be performed before removal of any supply from a drawer or cupboard
during surgery. Any supply removed from a drawer or cupboard during surgery is considered
contaminated following the surgical procedure. Such unused supplies must be
.
The patient chart should be placed on a clean surface away from patient contact surfaces
(such as the bed). Hand hygiene should be performed before and after handling the chart.
Where possible, program the telephone for auto-answer to permit hands-free handling of
incoming calls. Gloves should always be removed and hand hygiene performed prior to
handling the phone.
Remove patient set pans and return them to the Sterile Core (or equivalent) prior to patient
arrival.
The scrub nurse will contain all instruments, suction bottles and used anaesthetic equipment
in the case cart, where case carts are used. The case cart door will remain open until
housekeeping closes it prior to its removal for decontamination. Alternatively, where case
carts are not available, one or (preferably) two tables well removed from the operative site will
be designated for holding and keeping separate sterile and contaminated instruments
respectively; these will be covered with a drape at the end of the case. At the end of the
case, the cleaners/nurse will remove the cart or table(s) to be delivered to CSD for
cleaning/disinfection and the cleaners will perform cleaning of the room.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 152
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
All equipment brought into the room during a case, such as the C-arm, must remain in the
room until cleaned/disinfected by the cleaners.
Additional needed supplies should be passed directly to OR staff by Sterile Core (or
equivalent) personnel from the Sterile Core.
Where required, radiology aprons should be worn by scrubbed personnel under sterile gowns
for the entire case. Radiology aprons must be handled following hand hygiene.
All doors to the OR must be kept closed throughout surgeries. Entry to the OR suite during
surgery is strongly discouraged. Appropriate signage on the door (―No Entry‖) should support
this. OR staff should not generally enter the Sterile Core. Where necessary OR staff should
enter the Sterile Core directly from the OR, not from the outside corridor.
All unused sterile equipment must be returned to the Sterile Core or CSD.
Cleaning and disinfection must be performed for all cases sufficient to eradicate most
pathogens (including AROs) from the surgical environment and must be performed between
each case. Accelerated hydrogen peroxide (1:16) is the agent advocated for cleaning of all
surgical care areas since it meets this standard.
Enhanced cleaning or Two-Step cleaning using accelerated hydrogen peroxide may be
necessary in particular instances for patients/residents requiring Additional Precautions, on
the recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control (see the Surgical Housekeeping
Algorithm and the Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.)
Routine discharge cleaning practices will include cleaning of all horizontal (both sides) and
contact surfaces within the room that have been touched by the patient, surgeon, assistants,
and anesthetist, and includes the anesthetic cart, monitors and leads, dust covers on
keyboards and on equipment, as well as operating lights and switches. In addition, the floor
must be wet mopped. The walls are wiped when visibly soiled. Cleaning of the walls is done
daily, preferably at the end of the slate.
For any patient with increased risk of communicable disease transmission (i.e. infection, see
Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission and the Surgical
Housekeeping Algorithm), cleaning of the walls is done in conjunction with the Routine
Discharge Cleaning. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.
The room may be used again as soon as the indicated type of cleaning is complete.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 153
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2. Patient Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of
Infection
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Patients/residents should be treated with contact precautions when close personal care is
being provided (from pre-anaesthetic to operative to post-anaesthetic areas. The need for
Contact Precautions must be clearly communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas
(OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Appropriate signage should be placed on all doors to the OR.
In addition to routine dress code outlined above (see Page 152), the anaesthetist and
circulating nurse must wear shoe covers dedicated for the particular case. Other personal
barrier equipment/ clothing should be used as outlined under contact precautions.
The patient chart may be brought into the room and placed on a designated clean surface
away from patient contact surfaces (such as the bed and any over bed table, etc.). Hand
hygiene should be performed before and after handling the chart. Both the circulating nurse
and anesthetist may do charting on this surface, as long as gloves that have touched the
patient are removed before doing so and after hand hygiene. The chart may be returned to
the same pillowcase used for transport, as long as the inside of the pillowcase has not been
contaminated.
Gloves are always to be removed after activities where patient contact has occurred (e.g. IV
starts, intubations) before contact with clean items/areas. Hand hygiene must be performed
before and after glove use.
The patient bed or stretcher is to be taken out of the room and covered with a sheet. The
appropriate Additional Precautions sign is to be placed on top of the bed. At the end of the
case, the sheet should be removed from the bed and placed in the OR linen hamper. If the
bed or stretcher needs to be exchanged, housekeeping staff should be notified accordingly
and the bed should be stripped in the hall and cleaned (+/- Two-step cleaning as warranted)
before being put back into circulation. See Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.
Following the surgical procedure, the circulating nurse and/or anaesthetist and/or porter will
remove or exchange shoe covers and contaminated gloves and discard them before leaving
the OR. Hand hygiene with ABHR is to be done immediately following removal of
contaminated barrier clothing. Clean gloves must be worn for transport of the patient.
Pressing elevator buttons while wearing gloves for patient transport is acceptable, as there is
very low likelihood of contamination of the elevator button.
Garbage and linen may be collected as routine, unless alternative methods are requested by
Infection Prevention and Control. However, there should be no recycling performed.
The OR may be used for the next patient once Routine cleaning is completed.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 154
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
3. Cases with Infection – Contact and Droplet Precautions
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Patients/residents should be treated with appropriate contact or droplet precautions as
warranted at all times while in the surgical care areas (from pre-anaesthetic to operative to
post-anaesthetic areas). The need for contact or droplet precautions must be clearly
communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas (OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Appropriate signage should be placed on all doors to the OR.
In addition to routine dress code outlined above (see Page 152), the anaesthetist and
circulating nurse must wear shoe covers dedicated for the particular case. Other personal
barrier equipment/clothing should be used according to contact/droplet precautions.
The patient chart may be brought into the room and placed on a designated clean surface
away from patient contact surfaces (such as the bed and any over bed table, etc.). Hand
hygiene should be performed before and after handling the chart. Charting may be done on
this surface by both the circulating nurse and anaesthetist, as long as gloves that have
touched the patient are removed before doing so and after hand hygiene. The chart may be
returned to the same pillowcase used for transport, as long as the inside of the pillowcase has
not been contaminated.
Gloves are always to be removed after activities where patient contact has occurred (e.g. IV
starts, intubations) before contact with clean items/areas. Hand hygiene must be performed
before and after glove use.
The patient bed or stretcher is to be taken out of the room and covered with a sheet. The
appropriate additional precautions sign is to be placed on top of the bed. At the end of the
case, the sheet should be removed from the bed and placed in the OR linen hamper. If the
bed or stretcher needs to be exchanged, housekeeping staff should be notified accordingly
and the bed should be stripped in the hall and cleaned (+/- Two-step cleaning as warranted –
see Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology) before being put back into circulation.
Following the surgical procedure, the circulating nurse and/or anaesthetist and/or porter will
remove or exchange shoe covers and contaminated gloves and discard them before leaving
the OR. Hand washing or hand hygiene with ABHR is to be done immediately following
removal of contaminated barrier clothing. Clean gloves must be donned for transport of the
patient. Pressing elevator buttons, while wearing gloves for patient transport is acceptable,
as there is very low likelihood of contamination of the elevator button.
Garbage and linen may be collected as per routine, unless alternative methods are requested
by Infection Prevention and Control. However, there should be no recycling performed.
The OR may be used for the next patient once Routine Discharge Cleaning including the
walls is completed. This will include ―Routine Discharge Cleaning‖ as outlined above, as well
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 155
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
as cleaning of the walls. Enhanced cleaning or Two-Step cleaning using accelerated
hydrogen peroxide may be necessary in particular instances for patients/residents requiring
additional precautions, on the recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control. (See the
Surgical Housekeeping Algorithm and Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.)
4. Cases with Infection – Airborne Precautions
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Procedures for patients/residents requiring airborne precautions should only be performed if
negative air pressure can be assured within the OR relative to the hallway and adjacent
rooms.
Appropriate signage should be placed on the OR door.
In addition to routine dress code outlined above (see Page 152), all personnel in the OR must
wear an N95 mask (for which staff have been fit tested) at all times; see airborne precautions.
Additional precautions are necessary only if warranted.
Routine practices (including housekeeping) should be followed otherwise; see the Surgery
Booking Request Algorithm and the Surgical Housekeeping Algorithm.
E.
Procedure in the Post-Anaesthetic Area
1. Routine Practices
Routine practices are to be used by all personnel at all times.
A minimal amount of supplies should be stored in the patient stretcher area.
Cleaning and disinfection must be performed for all cases sufficient to eradicate most
pathogens (including AROs) from the surgical environment and must be performed between
each case. Accelerated hydrogen peroxide (1:16) is the agent advocated for cleaning of all
surgical care areas since it meets this standard.
Routine discharge cleaning practices after discharge of patient from PAR will include cleaning
of all horizontal and contact surfaces within the stretcher area that may have been touched by
the patient and staff, and includes counters, stretcher, monitors, IV poles, keyboard, etc. In
addition, the floor must be wet mopped. Headspace wall is wiped and bedside curtains
changed when visibly soiled; see the Surgical Housekeeping algorithm. Cleaning of the
headspace wall is done at minimum daily, preferably at the end of the slate.
Cleaning of the stretcher area for patients/residents on additional precautions will include the
above.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 156
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Routine discharge cleaning as well as the headspace wall, see the Surgical Housekeeping
algorithm.
The stretcher area may be used again as soon as the appropriate type of cleaning is
complete.
2. Patient Known to be Colonized with an ARO Without Evidence of
Infection
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Patients/residents should be treated with contact precautions when close personal care is
being provided (from pre-anesthetic to operative to post-anesthetic areas). The need for
contact precautions must be clearly communicated to other staff in the surgical care areas
(OR and post-anaesthetic area).
Patients/residents requiring additional precautions generally do not require placement in an
isolation room in the post-anesthetic area, but can be managed within the general postanesthetic area, as long as dedicated toileting facility is provided (e.g. dedicated commode)
and there is acceptable physical separation from adjacent stretchers (at least two metres/6
feet).
Patients/residents on contact precautions requiring nebulized therapy, non-invasive
ventilation or who have had a tracheostomy performed (not ventilated) are placed on droplet
precautions with a curtain around the stretcher; see Assessment for Increased Risk of
Communicable Disease Transmission.
Appropriate signage should be placed at the foot of the bed or on the curtain around the
stretcher.
Appropriate infection prevention and control barriers must be used for direct patient care; see
Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
The post-anaesthetic bay may be used for the next patient once routine discharge cleaning is
completed; see Surgical Housekeeping algorithm. Bedside curtains are changed if visibly
soiled.
Enhanced cleaning or Two-Step cleaning using accelerated hydrogen peroxide may be
necessary in particular instances for patients/residents requiring additional precautions, on
the recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control. (See Surgical Housekeeping
algorithm and Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.
3. Cases with Infection – Contact and Droplet Precautions
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 157
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Patients/residents requiring additional precautions generally do not require placement in an
isolation room in the post-anesthetic area, but can be managed within the general postanesthetic area, as long as dedicated toileting facility is provided (e.g. dedicated commode)
and there is acceptable physical separation from adjacent stretchers (at least two metres/6
feet).
Patients/residents on droplet precautions should be managed with additional physical barrier
of drawn curtains between patient bays.
Patients/residents on contact/droplet precautions requiring nebulized therapy, non-invasive
ventilation or who have had a tracheostomy performed (not ventilated) must be placed under
droplet precautions with the bedside curtain drawn around the stretcher.
Appropriate signage should be placed at the foot of the bed or on the bedside curtain.
Appropriate infection prevention and control barriers must be used for direct patient care; see
contact/droplet precautions.
The post-anesthetic bay may be used for the next patient once routine discharge cleaning,
including head space walls is completed; see Surgical Housekeeping algorithm. Where
patients/residents have been on droplet precautions, curtains should be changed between
patients/residents; see Surgical Housekeeping algorithm.
Enhanced cleaning or Two-Step cleaning using accelerated hydrogen peroxide may be
necessary in particular instances for patients/residents additional precautions, on the
recommendation of Infection Prevention and Control. (See Surgical Housekeeping algorithm
and Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.)
4. Cases with Infection – Airborne Precautions
See Assessment for Increased Risk of Communicable Disease Transmission.
Patients/residents requiring airborne precautions should be transferred to the postanaesthetic area wearing a surgical grade mask.
Patients/residents requiring airborne precautions should be recovered ONLY in a private
room in which negative air pressure can be assured within the room relative to the general
post-anesthetic area and adjacent rooms.
Appropriate signage should be placed on the isolation room door.
Any person entering the isolation room must wear an N95 mask (which staff must be fit tested
for) at all times. Additional precautions are necessary only if warranted; see airborne
precautions.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 158
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
The post-anaesthetic bay may be used for the next patient once routine cleaning is
completed; see the Surgical Housekeeping algorithm.
5.
Burn Unit Recommendations
Infection prevention and control begins at the time the patient is admitted to the hospital and
continues until the patient‘s graft sites have healed. Because of the nature of the burn
wound (loss of preventive covering of the skin) the burned patient is more susceptible to
invasive bacterial infection. The patient is ―autocontaminated‖ prior to arrival at the hospital
by the bacteria that survive in the hair follicles and sweat glands beneath the burned tissues,
and by the dirt from the burned clothing or accident environment. In addition, the burn wound
provides the media necessary for bacterial growth; food, warmth and moisture. Eliminating
reservoirs of infection begins with the patient and we must rely on aseptic technique as a
factor in controlling the infection inherent in the patient.
All patients/residents in the Burn Unit, Intensive and Intermediate, will be isolated.
Unit Isolation
Unit doors must be kept closed to maintain positive pressure when there are
patients/residents within the unit being treated for burns.
All disciplines (including medical staff and hospital services) must ensure they perform
thorough hand hygiene upon entering and exiting this unit. It is acceptable to use ABHR
or soap and water.
Nursing must ensure a clean, freshly laundered uniform is worn at the start of each shift.
Patient Room
Each patient‘s room is a separate isolation unit. Before entering:
Appropriate and thorough hand hygiene must be carried out before entering and upon
leaving room. Hand hygiene stations are provided for this purpose directly outside each
individual room.
PPE will be donned prior to entry of the patient‘s room. This includes isolation gowns,
caps, gloves and all other appropriate protective attire that may be necessary (masks,
face shield etc).
Upon exiting the patient‘s room, all PPE must be discarded in the appropriate receptacles
contained within the room and new attire donned if re-entering.
Housekeeping, food service employees and all other auxiliary staff must check with
nursing staff for direction prior to entering the patient‘s room.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 159
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Isolation Protocols
Isolation protocols must be instituted for all patients/residents treated for burns:
Private room must be used
Doors must be kept closed
Individual gown technique is imperative for all persons entering room
Surgical masks must be worn by all persons entering patient rooms
Hands must be washed as per policy by all personnel before entering, after leaving and as
otherwise indicated during patient care
Gloves – must be put on routinely by all personnel before entering and kept on until
discarded in a receptacle before leaving the room
Attire must be discarded in appropriate receptacle, then hands must be washed upon
leaving room
Visitors
Visitors entering the Unit:
Cap to be worn over hair
Clean, disposable protective gowns to be worn
Surgical mask to be worn
When leaving Unit, visitors will be instructed to discard all attire in laundry/garbage
hampers provided in the patient‘s room and wash hands
Visitors will be restricted to two persons per patient at a time
Visitors will be restricted to immediate family only (any deviation from this must be
approved by the person in charge)
Visitors will NOT be allowed to visit during treatment hours
If children are to visit, parents must be informed of all necessary precautions required and
ensure adherence to unit policy for both patient and visitor safety
Personal items such as bedding, clothing or any items made of fabric that cannot be
decontaminated appropriately are not permitted in the acute private rooms. Advice may
be obtained from Infection Prevention and Control for any questions
Real plants or flower arrangements are not permitted on the unit
Visitors must be instructed not to sit on patient‘s bed
Pets are not permitted on the unit at any time
Note: All Visitors must be made aware of the implications of visiting a patient treated for
burns and the importance of basic precautions and hand hygiene, especially when it is a new
burn and when not covered with a dressing.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 160
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Equipment and PPE
Other aspects of isolation within unit:
Sterile gloves are worn for contact with the burn wound
Protective gowns must be worn during wound care and hydrotherapy
All outside equipment will be cleaned with a disinfecting solution prior to being brought into
the unit. If the equipment is to be used for more than one patient, it must be disinfected
after each patient use
Items from Pharmacy, Central Sterilizing/Processing, Stores and Linen will be considered
clean and may be taken directly into unit
6.
Renal Dialysis Department
A.
Introduction
There is a high risk of infection from blood borne viruses and transmission of infectious
organisms in the dialysis setting from contaminated environmental surfaces and equipment,
inappropriate healthcare worker technique and person-to-person transmission. Stringent
infection prevention and control principles and procedures must be followed to decrease
these risks and ensure a safe level of care.
B.
Policy
Basic infection prevention and control principles must be met at all times to prevent
transmission of infectious disease and to ensure protection of patients/residents and staff in
the dialysis environment.
1. Guidelines for Patient Care
Ensure all staff are knowledgeable and well-trained and will adhere to the principles of
infection prevention and control, including implementation of routine practices
Use routine practices for all patients/residents
Maintain strict aseptic technique during all dialysis procedures
Implement routine monitoring and follow-up for signs and symptoms of any adverse
reaction, including local and systemic infection from vascular access or contamination
during dialysis
Advise patients/residents and visitors to complete hand hygiene prior to entering the
dialysis treatment station and on exit from the unit once dialysis is complete; ensure
pamphlets and adequate hand hygiene education are provided
Ensure appropriate signage with step by step instructions for hand hygiene are visible and
ABHR is available on entry and throughout the unit
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 161
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Healthcare workers must follow established guidelines for hand hygiene techniques
and procedures
Meticulous aseptic technique is critical to prevent vascular access site
contamination
Hand hygiene must be performed before and after palpating a vascular access site,
before and after inserting, replacing, accessing, repairing, or dressing an
intravascular catheter. Palpation of the insertion site should not be performed after
the application of antiseptic, unless aseptic technique is maintained.
Medication Administration
Common medication carts must not be used for medication. If trays are used to pass
medications, they must be cleaned in between patients/residents
Multiple dose medication vials must not be used between patients/residents. When they
are used, prepare individual patient doses in a clean area away from dialysis stations and
deliver separately to each patient
Medications should be mixed and stored in a designated, separate area, separate from
any contaminated/used supplies or equipment
IV medication or dilution vials labeled for single use should not be punctured more than
once. Once a needle has entered this type of vial, the sterility of the product can no longer
be guaranteed. Do not pool residual medication from multiple vials
Environment and Supplies
Cleaning and disinfection procedures must meet hospital requirements, including the use
of hospital approved disinfectants and cleaning solutions. Refer to the cleaning section of
the infection prevention and control manual for approved disinfectants
Blood spills must be managed appropriately following established VIHA Renal guidelines
Clean non-sterile gloves and waste containers should be placed near each dialysis station
Sufficient number of sinks with warm water and soap, and ABHR for when hands are not
visibly soiled must be available
Supply carts should not contain both clean supplies and blood-contaminated items and
should not be moved from within one patient space to another or stored in patient care
areas
Supplies and equipment labeled ‗single use only‘ must be dedicated for single patient use.
In instances where equipment is intended for multiple use, disinfection of items must be
performed between patients/residents
There must be a separate storage area for patient‘s articles
Patient Food and Snacks
Snacks supplied by the dialysis unit should be pre-wrapped only
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 162
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Dialysis chairs should be draped for patients/residents given foods that may spill on the
chair/bed. Drapes must be changed in between each patient. If a drape is not available,
thorough cleaning of the chair must be performed to remove all remnants of food prior to
the next patient‘s use
Patients/residents should be instructed to perform hand hygiene prior to eating
Waste
Discard all fluids and disinfect all surfaces and containers associated with prime waste
Waste generated from a hemodialysis facility should be considered potentially infectious
and handled according to local and provincial regulations governing medical waste
disposal
All disposable items containing fluids or biohazardous material should be placed in thick,
leak resistant bags and stored in appropriately constructed and labeled receptacles
Equipment
Non-disposable items that cannot be cleaned and disinfected (e.g. adhesive tape, cloth
covered BP cuffs etc), must be dedicated whenever possible for use on a single patient
only. If common use equipment cannot be dedicated, ensure adequate cleaning and
disinfection between patients/residents
There must be strict adherence to policy and procedures for the use, disinfection and
maintenance of hemodialysis machines and all dialysis related equipment
Manufacturer‘s recommendations must be followed
Refer to VIHA Reprocessing policy for decontamination of critical, semi-critical and
non critical equipment.
Items taken into a dialysis station, including those placed on top of dialysis machines, should
either be disposed of, dedicated for single patient use only, or cleaned and disinfected before
the next patient use or returning to storage.
Education
Regular updated education must be provided to patients/residents and their families,
clarifying their role in health maintenance and the prevention of dialysis-related
complications and infections.
2. Guidelines for Care of Vascular Access
Follow Established Guidelines Provided by the National Kidney Foundation–Kidney Dialysis
Outcomes Quality Initiative (NKF - KDOQI) for Selection and Maintenance of Vascular Access
for Hemodialysis.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 163
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Aseptic Procedure
Gloves must be changed between patients/residents and hand hygiene performed
Care to be taken to avoid touching surfaces with gloved hands that will later be touched
with ungloved hands
Staff must wear gowns, full face shields, or masks with eye protection to protect
themselves and their clothing when performing procedures in which blood or body fluid
splatter may occur (e.g., during initiation and termination of dialysis, cleaning of dialyzers
and centrifugation of blood)
Discard protective equipment in provided waste receptacles and linen hampers nearest
the dialysis station
Skin Antisepsis – Fistulas, Grafts and Catheters
Disinfect clean skin with an approved antiseptic before needle insertion and during
dressing changes
Approved antiseptics for cleansing fistula, graft, arterial catheters and central venous
catheter (CVC) insertion sites include a 2% chlorhexidine gluconate preparation as a first
choice
10% Povidone-Iodine solution or 70% alcohol may be used in the case of skin reaction to
chlorhexidine. If iodine is used, it must be allowed to dry for at least 2 minutes prior to skin
puncture
Sodium Hypochlorite solutions may be used as an alternate antiseptic at the discretion of
the Infection Prevention and Control Team
Any other solution to be used for vascular access site care must be first approved by
Infection Prevention and Control Team
Catheter Site Dressing Regime
A new sterile dressing should be applied with each dialysis treatment
A topical antibiotic ointment should be applied at the catheter exit sites whenever possible
to help reduce the risk of infection
A dry gauze dressing is the recommended choice, and should be applied with each
dialysis treatment and replaced when site inspection is required or the dressing becomes
loosened or soiled
Patients/residents should be instructed to keep the CVC dressing clean and dry, to
replace the dressing if it becomes damp, soiled or loosened and to report to their
healthcare provider any changes in their catheter site or any new discomfort at the site
Occlusive transparent dressings:
If a transparent dressing is used, chose a product with a high-moisture vapor
transmission rate to prevent increased moisture accumulation under the dressing
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 164
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
(some types of these dressings are associated with an increase in microbial growth
under the dressing and thus an increase risk of infection)
Follow established BC Renal Agency guidelines for transparent dressing care
policy
Occlusive dressings are less compatible with the use of antimicrobial ointment at
catheter exit sites
3. Surveillance
Surveillance of important blood borne viruses and AROs will be performed on a routine basis
for monitoring and infection prevention and control purposes.
ARO Screening for Renal Dialysis Patients/Residents
Prevalence Screening
Prevalence screening for AROs are organized by Infection Prevention and Control at
regularly scheduled time frames
Frequency of screening and information collected is reviewed annually and in consultation
with the renal dialysis group to establish if there are indications for further surveillance
Prevalence screening may be performed more frequently at the direction of Infection
Prevention and Control during times of increased incidence, outbreaks and heightened
surveillance, etc.
MRSA screening includes:
Swabs to be collected prior to commencement of dialysis and then annually on the
patient‘s birthday
Swab sites include both nares (one swab), rectal swab (one swab), large (draining)
wounds.
VRE screening Includes:
Swabs to be collected prior to commencement of dialysis and then annually on the
patient‘s birthday
VRE point prevalence (collecting swabs from all patients/residents at a set point in time)
will be performed twice yearly
VRE swab sites include a rectal swab, ostomy swab (swab should be stool stained; collect
both ostomy and rectal swab only if patient continues to pass fluid/stool through rectum)
and any large draining wounds.
Screening Requirements for Patients/Residents Not Known to be ARO Positive
Screening for MRSA/VRE is to be completed:
On initial admission to any hemodialysis or peritoneal dialysis facility
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 165
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Upon returning from travel (within or outside BC, for any period of time)
Upon return from admission to an acute care hospital or residential care facility (unless
already collected within the last 48 hours)
When peritoneal dialysis patients/residents require temporary hemodialysis unless
swabbed within the previous 48 hours
Incoming Visiting Patients/Residents (Travelers)
The patient‘s current ARO status should be received within 2-4 weeks prior to the patient‘s
arrival to the dialysis unit. A risk assessment should be made on arrival to the dialysis unit
Visiting dialysis patients/residents should be screened for MRSA and VRE upon their
initial arrival to the dialysis unit
Patients/residents returning from travel outside Canada should be screened with a risk
assessment completed to determine if additional precautions are necessary until negative
results are available.
Outgoing Traveling Patients/Residents
For patients/residents traveling outside BC: If requested, current ARO culture results
should be provided to the receiving dialysis unit along with the patient‘s clinical information
Monitoring ARO Status for Patients/Residents Known to be MRSA or VRE Positive
Patients/residents noted to be ARO positive are not routinely screened for the known ARO.
However, upon patient or Infection Prevention and Control‘s request, requirements for alert
removal and discontinuation of precautions include:
all ARO positive patients/residents must have stopped all antibiotics (topical and oral,
including decolonization protocol if MRSA positive) at least one week (or one month if
infected) prior to collecting swabs
MRSA
Collect two sets of swabs, at least one week apart
Wait at least one week after the last positive culture if the patient was colonized
Wait one month from the last positive culture if the patient had an ARO infection
If both sets of results are negative and the patient has not been on oral/topical antibiotics
contact Infection Prevention and Control for further guidance
MRSA decolonization is not routinely performed (clinical indications such as large draining
wounds require further assessment), but may be an option for some patients/residents.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 166
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
VRE
Collect two sets of swabs, at least one month apart
Wait at least one month after the last positive culture
If both sets of results are negative and the patient has not been on topical/oral
antibiotics contact Infection Prevention and Control for further guidance
Consult with Infection Prevention and Control
Consult with the Infection Prevention and Control prior to discontinuing precautions for
final approval
Contact Infection Prevention and Control prior to discontinuing precautions on
patients/residents with multi-ARO (e.g. VRE and MRSA)
Consult with Infection Prevention and Control for follow up of ESBL
4. Acute Care Patients Receiving Dialysis
Patients admitted to acute care hospitals who meet the admission screening questionnaire
criteria should have swabs collected
Patients admitted to acute care must have a discharge swab collected
5. Residential Care Residents Receiving Dialysis
Residents admitted to acute care from a residential care facility and meet the admission
screening questionnaire criteria should have swabs collected
Note: In instances where Infection Prevention and Control has approved for a patient to
personally collect an ARO swab, the patient must be given the appropriate pamphlet with
accurate instructions to guide their technique and to ensure VIHA has access to results.
Consult with Infection Prevention and Control first.
6. Routine Surveillance, Evaluation and Management of
Communicable Diseases
Refer to CDC Recommendations: Guidelines for Vaccinating Kidney Dialysis
Patients/Residents and Patients/Residents with Chronic Kidney Disease (Recommendations
of the Advisory Committee on Immunization Practices –ACIP) for further recommended
guidelines for surveillance and patient vaccinations
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 167
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
7. Guidelines for Patients/Residents Requiring Additional
Precautions
Patients/residents who exhibit the following require additional precautions while receiving
treatment at a renal dialysis unit:
Known to have a confirmed ARO (MRSA, VRE or ESBL)
Confirmed C.difficile
Undiagnosed diarrhea
Large open draining wounds
Productive cough
Patient Placement for Dialysis
Patients/residents known to be positive with an ARO should be cared for in a private room if
available, but may also be cohorted with patients/residents of the same ARO in a shared
room or area (complete a risk assessment for signs and symptoms of infection prior to
cohorting). The cohorted area is a defined geographical area in the hemodialysis unit with
physical separation from other dialysis stations
Note: for patients/residents known to be ARO positive, whether or not cohorting is possible,
the patient‘s dialysis station must be thoroughly cleaned prior to the next patient‘s treatment
Visitors
In order to maintain a safe patient environment:
Visitors will perform hand hygiene on entry and exit to the dialysis unit. Education and
pamphlets must be provided to ensure appropriate technique
Visitors should don gowns and gloves when providing direct patient care. Information will
be given to visitors on the importance of hand hygiene while in the renal dialysis
environment
Visitors should not enter other patient‘s dialysis stations and should not be present during
times when vascular access is occurring
8. Guidelines for Outbreak Management
Patients/residents receiving dialysis who are transferred from an outbreak unit must be
placed on the appropriate precautions with the appropriate cleaning provided when the
patient has left the station. Patients/residents should be dialyzed in an area separate from
others whenever possible.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 168
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
9. Guidelines for Cleaning and Disinfection
The following cleaning practices must be met performed between all patients/residents:
Clean and disinfect dialysis station (chairs, beds, tables, machines) between each patient
with a recommended disinfectant
Special attention to be paid to cleaning control panels on the dialysis machines and other
surfaces that are frequently touched and potentially contaminated with patients/residents
blood
Discard all fluids, clean and disinfect all surfaces, tubing and containers associated with
the prime waste (including buckets attached to the machines if applicable)
Dialysis machines:
o Surface must be cleaned between each patient; interior to be cleaned by technician or
designated personnel daily or immediately if contaminated, according to the
Association for the Advancement of Medical Instrumentation (AAMI), the Canadian
Standards Association (CSA) and manufacturer‘s recommendations
Curtains should be changed when visibly soiled and routinely on a monthly basis. In
areas where patients/residents known to be ARO positive are cohorted change curtains
weekly
Telephones, keyboards and general office surfaces must be cleaned daily. All keyboards
should be covered. Use alcohol swabs or hydrogen peroxide wipes for covered
keyboards. Nursing staff/Unit clerks to provide additional cleans throughout the day
following use
For patients/residents with undiagnosed diarrhea or symptoms of diagnosed Norovirus or
C.difficile, a two-step clean is necessary (see Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology.)
For patients/residents known to be VRE positive, enhanced cleaning is implemented
between patients/residents (see Housekeeping Cleaning Terminology).
Table 24: Disinfection Procedures Recommended for Commonly Used Items or Surfaces in
Hemodialysis Units
Item or Surface
Gross blood spills or items
contaminated with visible blood
Hemodialyzer port caps
Water treatment and distribution
system
Scissors, hemostats, clamps,
blood pressure cuffs,
stethoscopes
Low level Disinfection
Intermediate level
disinfection 30
X
X
X
X 31
X
X 32
30
Careful mechanical cleaning to remove debris should always be done before disinfection. If item is visibly
contaminated with blood, use a tuberculocidal disinfectant.
31
Water treatment and distribution systems of dialysis fluid concentrates require more extensive disinfection if
significant biofilm is present within the system.
32
If item is visibly contaminated with blood, use a tuberculocidal disinfectant.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 169
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Environmental surfaces, including
exterior surfaces of hemodialysis
machines
X
Adapted from: CDC MMWR Vol 50/No.RR-5, 2001
Care and Maintenance of the Dialysis System
AAMI and CSA standards must be followed
Manufacturer‘s recommendations must be followed
Water Treatment for Dialysis
Dialysis units must meet or exceed AAMI and CSA standards for hemodialysis water
purity, quality and monitoring
Water samples should be collected at the point where water enters the dialysate
concentrate proportioning unit
Dialysis fluid samples should be taken from the entry or exit point of the dialyzer during or
at termination of dialysis
If acceptable levels are exceeded, disinfection of the water system must occur and repeat
samples taken prior to use
Written procedures must be available, outlining all testing policy and procedures, actions
performed if contamination levels are exceeded and how documentation and records are
maintained
10. Guidelines for Peritoneal Dialysis
Infection prevention and control Considerations:
Strict use of aseptic technique and sterile dressings are required for the operative wound
and exit sites until well healed
Perform aseptic manipulation of the sterile disposable lines that deliver dialysis fluid into
the peritoneal cavity for peritoneal dialysis and aseptic connection of the tubing to the
patients/residents‘ catheter
Wear gloves whenever there is any potential contact with dialysis effluent, during exit-site
care, and when drawing blood or taking dialysate samples. Wear gloves, gown and face
shield when disposing of the effluent
Peritoneal effluent should be considered potentially infectious for bloodborne pathogens
PD drains must be used for draining peritoneal/dialysate only
Patients/residents must be instructed on proper use of these sinks and shown
where sinks designated for personal care and hand washing are located.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 170
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Peritoneal Dialysis sinks: On a weekly basis, peritoneal dialysis sinks will be disinfected using
a bleach solution of 100 mL of 5% household bleach diluted in 900 mL of water (for a 1:9 ratio
of 1 part bleach to 9 parts water out of a total of 10 parts). Pour the solution down the sink
drain, let it sit for 5–10 minutes, and follow with a water flush. Notify maintenance
immediately if there is any residue or clogs noted in the drain.
Sources:
American Institute of Architects. (2006). Renal Dialysis unit (acute and chronic) Guidelines for design and
construction of healthcare facilities. (pp.93-96). Washington, DC: American Institute of Architects.
Association for Advancement of Medical Instrumentation. (2003). AAMI standards and recommended
practices, dialysis. Arlington, VA: American National Standards Institute
Association for Professionals in Infection Control and Epidemiology. (2004). Infection control in ambulatory
care. (pp.98-107). Washington, DC: Association for Professionals in Infection Control and Epidemiology.
Association for Professionals in Infection Control and Epidemiology. (2005). Dialysis. APIC text of infection
nd
control and epidemiology 2 edition. (pp.1-15). Washington, DC: Association for Professionals in Infection
Control and Epidemiology.
Bender, F., Bernardini, J., & Piraino, B. (2006) Prevention of infectious complications in peritoneal dialysis:
Best demonstrated practices. Kidney International, 70, 44-54.
Bianchi, P,. Buoncristiani, E., Buoncristiani, U. (2007). Disinfection by sodium hypochlorite: Dialysis
applications. Contributions to Nephrology. 154, 1-6.
BC Renal Agency. (2008). Prevention, treatment and monitoring of vascular access related infection in
hemodialysis patients: Vascular access guideline
Brunch, M. (2007. Toxicity and safety of topical sodium hypochlorite. Contributions to Nephrology, 154, 24-38.
Center for Disease Control. (2001). Recommendations for preventing transmission of infections among chronic
hemodialysis patients. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report. 50 (RR-5), 1-43.
Center for Disease Control. (2002). Guidelines for prevention of intravascular catheter related infections,
Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report. 51(RR-10), 1-26.
Center for Disease Control. (2003). Guideline for environmental infection control in health care facilities.
Center for Disease Control. (2006). Guidelines for vaccinating kidney dialysis patients and patients with chronic
kidney disease (summarized from recommendations of the advisory committee on immunization practices).
Department of Health. (2002). Good practice guidelines for renal dialysis/transplantation units: Prevention and
control of blood borne virus infection.
De Vos, J., Elseviers, M., Harrington, M., Zampieron, A., Vlaminck, H., Ormandy, P., et al. (2006). Infection
control practice across Europe: Results of the European practice database project. EDTNA/ERCA Journal, 32
(1), 38-41.
Health Canada. (1999). Infection control guidelines: Routine practices and additional precautions for
preventing the transmission of infection in health care. Canada Communicable Disease Report. Vol. 25S4.
Lam, L. D., Newman, A., & CHICA Dialysis Interest Group. (2005). A survey of infection control practices in
hemodiaysis units in Canada. Canadian Journal of Infection Control, 20(3), 118-136.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 171
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Mendoza-Guevara, L., Castro-Vazquez, F., Aquilar-Kitsu, A., Morales-Nava, A., Rodriguez-Leyva, F. SanchezBarbosa, J.L. (2007). Amuchina 10% solution, safe antiseptic for preventing infections of exit-site of Techkhoff
catheters, in the pediatric population of a dialysis program. Contributions to Nephrology. 154, 139-144.
National Center for Infectious Diseases. (1999). National surveillance of dialysis-associated diseases in the
united states. Atlanta, Georgia: Public Health Service, Department of Health and Human Services.
National Kidney Foundation. (2006). Clinical practice guidelines for peritoneal dialysis adequacy: Update 2006.
National Kidney Foundation. (2006). Kidney dialysis outcomes quality initiative, clinical practice guidelines for
vascular access: Update 2006.
Peleman, R., Vogelaers, D., & Verschraegen, G. (2000). Changing patterns of antibiotic resistance-update on
antibiotic management of the infected vascular access. European Renal Association –European Dialysis and
Transplant Association, 15, 1281-1284.
Taal, M,. Fluck, R., & McIntyre, W. (2006). Preventing catheter related infections in hemodialysis patients.
Current Opinion in Nephrology and Hypertension. 15, 599-602.
Vancouver Coastal Hospital Infection Prevention and Control Manual. (2006). Vancouver coastal infection
control guidelines for hemodialysis patients with antibiotic resistant organisms (revised December 2005 and
January 2006).
Zuckerman, M. (2002). Surveillance and control of blood-borne virus infections in haemodialysis units. Journal
of Hospital Infection, 50, 1-5.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 172
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
7.
Respiratory Department Guidelines
A.
Introduction
Prevention and control of hospital-acquired infections associated with respiratory therapy is
dependent upon adequate procedures for maintenance and operation, including the use of
strict aseptic technique, routine practices and appropriate reprocessing methods.
B.
Equipment
Microorganisms found in respiratory equipment often come from the patient during
breathing or coughing into the system. It is essential that this contamination be destroyed
or removed from all reusable apparatus
Routine practices must be used for handling all used equipment. All contaminated
equipment must be cleaned and decontaminated before attempting sterilization
Follow the manufacturers‘ recommendations for disassembling equipment and for
cleaning and decontamination
The outside surfaces of large pieces of equipment should be cleaned and disinfected after
use (e.g. nebulizers, oxygen tents, humidifiers, incubators, compressors etc.). Clean
thoroughly using a hospital approved detergent and/or disinfectant that is consistent with
manufacturer‘s recommendations
Cover and protect all equipment when not in use
For guidelines regarding the appropriate care and use of specific respiratory equipment,
solutions and products, refer to established VIHA Respiratory Therapy policy and
procedure
If an outbreak is suspected, notify Infection Prevention and Control. The Infection Control
Practitioner will coordinate all swabs collected from equipment for laboratory analysis
C.
Disposable Equipment
A wide variety of disposable equipment is available and should be used whenever
possible, especially in the care of patients/residents where there is a risk of contact with
potentially infectious body fluids, excretions and secretions
Single use items must not be reprocessed, according to VIHA Reprocessing Manual.
D.
Respiratory Patients/Residents Requiring Additional
Precautions
A risk assessment must be completed prior to initiating any respiratory procedure to
determine which additional precautions are necessary.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 173
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
For all respiratory procedures, such as sputum induction, nasal-pharyngeal
washes/specimen collection, use of nebulizers etc, refer to established VIHA Respiratory
Therapy policy and procedure.
1. Guidelines for Ventilator Associated Pneumonia (VAP)
Definition
Ventilator associated pneumonia is defined by CDC as a condition in patients/residents on
mechanical ventilation for > 48hrs, who present with fever, cough and new onset of purulent
sputum, combined with:
Radiologic evidence of a new or progressive pulmonary infiltrate
Leukocytosis
A suggestive Gram's stain
Growth of bacteria in cultures of sputum, tracheal aspirate, pleural fluid, or blood.
Reference: CDC Guidelines for Preventing Health-care associated Pneumonia, 2003
VAP Prevention Strategies
Surveillance
Infection Prevention and Control conducts ongoing surveillance for all new cases of
pneumonia, including patients/residents at high risk for healthcare related pneumonia such
as those admitted to ICU, mechanically ventilated patients/residents or high risk surgical
patients/residents
Goals of surveillance:
Identify outbreaks early
Ensure the appropriate precautions and education are put into place
Determine trends and help identify practices that require closer review and
education.
Cross Contamination
Routine Practices must be adhered to at all times, including:
Use of gloves before handling respiratory secretions or contaminated objects
Appropriate hand hygiene (soap and water or ABHR) before and after any contact with the
patient or equipment in the patient‘s environment; before and after contact with mucous
membranes or any respiratory secretions
Use of gown (impermeable) when contact with respiratory secretions are anticipated
Use of mask when contact with respiratory secretions are anticipated and when
performing procedures that induce coughing or create aerosol
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 174
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Airway Management
Perform orotracheal rather than nasotracheal intubation, unless contraindicated
Ensure secretions are removed from above the cuff prior to deflating the cuff of an ET tube
when repositioning or removing
Gastric Reflux Prevention
Maintain elevation of the head of the bed between 30 – 45 degrees unless contraindicated
Ensure routine verification of placement of feeding tube
Equipment
For maintenance care, ensure there is periodic draining and discarding of any condensate
collected in the tubing
Ensure condensate is not able to drain toward the patient
Oral Care
Ensure standard practice for thorough oral care/decontamination is available and utilized
Sources:
Centre for Disease Control. (2003), Guidelines for environmental infection control in health care facilities.
Morbidity and mortality weekly report, 52(RR10), 1-42.
Chulay, M. (2005). VAP prevention: The latest guidelines. RN, 68(3), 53-56.
Evans, E. (2005). Best-practice protocols: VAP prevention. Nursing Management, 36(12), 10-16.
Favero, M.S., Bond, W.W. (1991). Sterilization, disinfection and antisepsis in the hospital manual of clinical
microbiology. Washington, DC: American Society for Microbiology.
Ohana, S., Denys, P., Guillemot, D., Lortat-jacob, S., Ronco, E., Rottman, M., et al. (2006). Control of an ACC1-producing Klebsiella pneumonia outbreak in a physical medicine and rehabilitation unit. Journal of Hospital
Infection, 63, 34-38.
O‘Keefe-McCarthy, S. (2006). Evidence-based nursing strategies to prevent ventilator-acquired pneumonia.
Canadian Association of Critical Care Nurses, 17(1), 8-11.
Powers, J. (2006). Managing VAP effectively to optimize outcomes and costs. Nursing Management Supp, 37,
48b-48f.
Vancouver Island Health Authority. (2008). Respiratory therapy policy and procedure.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 175
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PART 8: Specific Procedural Recommendations
1.
Asepsis
Aseptic technique can be defined as all the measures we take to purposefully reduce the
number of microorganisms to an irreducible number for the purpose of preventing
transmission of infection. The strictness (or level) of aseptic technique increases as you
perform more invasive procedures. For example, taking a blood pressure requires only clean
technique, while procedures that enter a sterile body cavity require sterile technique.
Microorganisms Live In and On Our Bodies
Transient microorganisms are easily picked up on hands, clothing, inanimate objects, etc.,
and are easily removed by hand washing and cleaning (physical removal of "germs"),
antisepsis and disinfection. Antisepsis (or hand washing and pre-op skin preparation) is the
removal of transient microorganisms from the skin with a reduction in the resident flora.
Resident or Normal Flora are those microorganisms that are constantly present on our
bodies; no amount of scrubbing will totally remove them (the skin cannot be made sterile).
These organisms cause "trouble" when introduced into normally sterile areas (like the bladder
or bloodstream).
Pathogens: Microorganisms that nearly always produce disease. For example: Salmonella
and Shigella cause diarrheal illness upon ingestion of enough organisms. Normal flora can
become pathogenic when introduced into areas where they don't belong, for example,
through insertion of a catheter or through surgery. S. epidermidis, normal flora of the skin,
causes most central line infections and hip implant infections.
The Seven Keys of Asepsis
Know what is clean
Know what is contaminated
Know what is sterile
Keep clean, contaminated and sterile items separated
Keep sterile sites sterile
Resolve contamination immediately
Train yourself to realize when you have broken technique
Know what is clean
Clean techniques are any procedures that involve contact with intact skin or mucous
membranes only. For example, when you are taking blood pressure or temperature, these
articles need to be clean only.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 176
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Know what is contaminated
Certain procedures like dressing changes produce contaminated materials. These
contaminated materials must be disposed of properly by incineration or autoclave. Touching
non-intact skin is a contaminated procedure; wear clean gloves unless a sterile procedure
(like a dressing change) is being done.
Know what is sterile
During certain procedures (for example, the insertion of an IV or urinary catheter), sterile
technique must be used. The level of sterile procedures increases with the level of
invasiveness. For example, surgical procedures require stricter aseptic technique than
starting an IV. Sterile gloves are required for sterile procedures.
Keep clean, contaminated and sterile items separated
Keep contaminated articles from touching clean or sterile items. Store clean and sterile items
separately from contaminated areas or items. Keep sterile items from touching anything but a
sterile field or another sterile item.
Keep sterile sites sterile
Once a tube has been inserted into the body, care must be given to mitigate the travel of
microorganisms up the catheter or tube. Give dressing changes or catheter care and replace
catheters per your facility's policy and procedure.
Resolve contamination immediately
If sterile technique cannot be used or is broken (e.g. during an emergency), resolve
contamination when it occurs. For example, if an IV is inserted during an emergency, replace
the IV as soon as possible after the code is completed.
Train yourself to realize when you have broken technique
If a technique is broken, remedy the problem if possible. For example, if during the insertion
of an IV the catheter is contaminated by touching a non-sterile surface, replace the catheter
before insertion. If contamination cannot be resolved, report it to the proper person. For
example, if the bowel is nicked during surgery, the case classification will change from clean
or clean-contaminated to contaminated and extra care should be given to prevent infection.
For details on approved disinfectants and antiseptics for different procedures see the Table
below – Approved Antiseptic Agents and Procedures.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 177
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Reference: Rhodes, M. (2003) The ABCs of Infection Control. Infection control Today Magazine
Table 25: Approved Antiseptic Agents and Procedures
PURPOSE OF SKIN
PREPARATION
Patient’s personal
hygiene
AGENT(S)
CONTACT TIME
Neutral soap
10-15 seconds
Alcohol antisepsis
15 seconds
Neutral soap
10-15 seconds
Hand antisepsis Alcohol based hand
rub
Approved alcohol based
hand rub
15 seconds
Aseptic hand scrub or
rub
CHG 2% detergent
Povidone Iodine 10%
Approved alcohol based
hand rub
3-5 minutes
3-5 minutes
2-3 minutes
Preparation of skin for
intramuscular or
subcutaneous
injections
70% Isopropyl alcohol
Until dry
Preparation of skin for
peripheral venous
access
CHG 2% with 70%
isopropyl (preferred)
or 70% Isopropyl
alcohol
Povidone Iodine 10%,
followed by 70%
Isopropyl alcohol
Until dry
Withdrawal of blood for
other studies
70% Isopropyl alcohol
Until dry
Preparation of skin site
before insertion of
arterial, central, or
epidural lines,
hemodialysis access or
any inserting any
scope through the skin
Adults: 2% CHG with
70% Isopropyl alcohol
Until dry
Staff hygiene
Social hand wash
Preparation of skin for:
Withdrawal of blood for
culture and sensitivity
COMMENTS
Hand hygiene to be promoted
after toileting and before
meals
Hand hygiene to be promoted
after toileting and before
meals
Attention to nails. Remove
rings and watches. Perform
when hands visibly soiled and
when managing C.difficile
patients/residents.
Use as first line or routine
approach to hand hygiene.
*Do not use if hands visibly
soiled or when managing
C.difficile.
To be performed prior to
aseptic procedures. If alcohol
based hand rub used, 2-3
liberal applications rubbed all
surfaces-hands, wrists,
forearms
Care not to retouch prepared
skin surface
For neonates or if allergic to
Povidone Iodine: 2% CHG
with 70% Isopropyl alcohol
Until dry (at least 2
minutes)
Neonates: 2% CHG (no
alcohol)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Amuchina 10% (Except Plus)
for hemodialysis
patients/residents with skin
allergy or sensitivity
Page 178
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
PURPOSE OF SKIN
PREPARATION
Ongoing care of sites
used for line access to
a sterile space
AGENT(S)
CONTACT TIME
COMMENTS
2% CHG with 4%
alcohol preservative
Until dry
Care of wounds post
surgical or trauma
Sterile normal saline
Wipe dry with sterile
gauze
Care of pin sites
Sterile normal saline
and/or hydrogen
peroxide 3%; or
Povidone Iodine 10%
Until dry
Care of decubiti
Sterile normal saline or
CHG 2% solution
or Povidone Iodine 10%
Preparation for
gynecologic
examination
None (see comments)
Good perineal washing.
Colposcopy – Povidone Iodine
10%.
Urinary
Catheterization/Urology
Normal Saline (see
comments)
Good perineal washing
CHG 4% (see comment)
Shower night before and
morning of surgery with CHG
4%. Rinse well.
Open containers to be
discarded and replaced after
24 hours
Ortho: Cleanse daily and prn
with normal saline; gently
remove scabbing. Other
Specialties: Check with MRP
for orders.
Saline used if discharge is
present
Pre-operative skin prep
In-house
Same day surgical
admissions:
Patient arrives with:
only 1 application of
CHG 4%
Patient arrives with:
no applications of CHG
4% completed; or allergy
to CHG 4%
3 minutes
CHG 4% (see comment)
Coach patient to allow lather
to remain on skin for 3
minutes
Apply once to surgical area for
3 minutes. Rinse area
thoroughly.
As per VIHA Nursing Policy &
Procedure Manual.
PCMX; or Povidone
Iodine scrub.
Note: Once opened, bottles of sterile normal saline should be dated, and used up or discarded, preferably by
the end of each shift and certainly within 24 hours of opening.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 179
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
2.
Environment and Furniture in Patient Care Areas
A.
Furniture
General
All furniture should be constructed in a way that permits cleaning of all surfaces
The size, shape and design of the furniture must allow easy access to cleaning staff
Risk Levels
Vinyl is required for furnishings in high risk areas
High level of risk applies to any area specifically used by patients/residents (i.e. patient
rooms, waiting rooms) and any area where a healthcare worker goes after providing
direct patient care (e.g. nursing station, staff lounge, report area, conference rooms,
offices within patient care areas
Durable, cleanable fabrics are appropriate in low risk areas
Low level of risk applies to any office areas where staff are not providing direct patient
care, or return to after providing direct patient care
Fabric
Fabric must be impermeable to water, stain resistant and made of a material that does not
promote the growth of microorganisms
The material should be durable, easily cleaned and withstand cleaning with institutional
cleaning/disinfecting solutions. Their selection should be based on an understanding of
the principles of decontamination and maintenance requirements (e.g. able to withstand
multiple application of diluted disinfectants over time)
Limit the amount of pleating in fabric and make sure the seams are sealed
There should be limited off-gassing from the fabric
Other Materials
Plastic laminate furniture offer good designs and realistic wood grain patterns. Another
option combines polyurethane sealed woods on vertical surfaces with solid surfacing on
horizontal surfaces
The purchasing of new wood furniture is not recommended. Existing wood furniture must
be assessed regularly to assure that the finish remains sealed (note: wood furniture
requires regular maintenance to keep lacquer intact)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 180
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Note: The above criteria apply to all clinical areas throughout the healthcare system – patient
rooms, waiting rooms, unit offices (i.e. social worker, coordinator, manager), nurses‘ station,
staff rooms and conference rooms. Fabric, if desired, is acceptable in
administrative/executive offices and related meeting areas.
B.
Fixtures and Fittings
General
All fixtures and fittings should prevent the collection of dust and growth of mold, mildew
and other microorganisms
They must be easy to maintain, and have proven durability under actual conditions of use
and maintenance in healthcare facilities
Curtains and blinds
Curtains can easily become contaminated with microorganisms. All curtains must be able
to withstand a washing process at disinfection temperatures (71 c for 25 minutes or more),
or be able to withstand the washing/drying sanitizing processes that occur in an industrial
or institutional setting
Venetian horizontal blinds are not recommended as they become dusty and difficult to
clean. Certain vertical blinds may be acceptable if design allows appropriate cleaning
Blinds need to be of a construction that allows cleaning of all surfaces and functional parts
Fittings
The use of lamps with fabric shades is not recommended
If fabric shades used, the fabric must be removable and be able to withstand washing
temperatures of 71 c for 3 minutes or 65 c for 10 minutes
It is recommended to avoid lamps that have pull strings for operation, unless it is a
material that is easily cleaned and will not rust
Ceiling lights and wall mounted fixtures should have lenses and enclosed housings
Vanity tops
Vanity tops must be constructed of a solid surface material, with integrated bowl and
backsplash
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 181
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Handrails and Other Hardware
Stainless steel remains the material of choice for handrails and other hardware, because
of its durability and ease of maintenance
Wood is acceptable if sealed, but requires ongoing maintenance
Ceilings
The ceiling must be cleanable and built to prevent the infiltration of dust from the plenum
space
The ceiling should be made of a material that does not promote the growth of
microorganisms
Walls
Low volatile organic compound (VOC) scrub-able paint must be used
If vinyl wall covering is selected, it should have minimal texture to facilitate thorough
cleaning
All wall coating/covering and adhesives used must have antimicrobial treatments where
available
Floors
Sheet vinyl flooring with welded seams and an integral cove base
Carpeting in patient care areas is strongly discouraged
Posted Signage and Other Posted Materials
Most signage presents a very low risk for transmission of organisms.
Determination of whether a sign/poster that is posted should be laminated is based upon the
following considerations:
Length of time it is likely to be posted
Whether the signage is for long term use and is stored between uses
Whether the signage would require a wipe down of its surfaces when area is cleaned
Risk of contamination based on where it will be posted – low frequency or high
frequency touch areas
Where it will be used – patient care area, staff rooms, office/business area.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 182
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
When a poster/sign is developed for posting and a decision needs to be made regarding
lamination, the following four basic principles should be considered:
1. Laminate the poster/sign if it will be posted for a long-term period (30 days or
greater), or stored and re-used (i.e. precaution signs)
2. Don‘t laminate if poster/sign is to be posted for short term (less than 30 days)
3. If not laminated, remove and replace if it becomes dirty, tattered, or torn
4. If the poster/sign is to be posted in a patient or staff bathroom or dirty utility room, it
must be laminated regardless of the duration of use
Please note: Sheet protectors are not recommended as an alternate to lamination because
they cannot be easily cleaned and require tape to seal the top.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 183
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
APPENDICES
APPENDIX A: Type and Duration of Additional Precautions
Where Recommended for Selected Infections and Conditions
Legend:
Precautions used in addition to Routine Practices
Type of Precautions:
A
-
AIRBORNE
C
-
CONTACT
D
-
DROPLET
R
-
ROUTINE PRACTICES
Duration of Precautions:
CN
DI
-
Until off antimicrobial treatment and culture negative
DE
U
-
Until the environment is completely decontaminated
Unknown
-
Criteria for establishing eradication of pathogen has
not bee determined
Duration of illness (with wound lesions, DI means
until wounds stop draining)
Until time specified in hours (hrs) after initiation of
effective therapy
Adapted from: Siegel JD, Rhinehart E, Jackson M, Chiarello L, and the Healthcare Infection Control Practices
Advisory Committee, 2007 Guideline for Isolation Precautions: preventing Transmission of Infectious Agents in
Healthcare Settings, June 2007
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 184
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
Draining, major
C
DI
No dressing or containment of
drainage; until drainage stops or can be
contained by dressing.
Draining, minor or limited
R
Dressing covers and contains drainage.
Acquired human
immunodeficiency syndrome
(HIV)
R
Post-exposure chemoprophylaxis for
some blood and body fluid exposures.
Actinomycosis
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Amebiasis
R
Person to person transmission is rare.
Transmission in settings for the
mentally challenged and in a family
group has been reported. Use care
when handling diapered infants and
mentally challenged persons.
Anthrax
R
Infected patients/residents do not
generally pose a transmission risk.
Cutaneous Anthrax
R
Transmission through non-intact skin
contact with draining lesions possible,
therefore use Contact Precautions if
large amount of uncontained drainage.
Handwashing with soap and water
preferable to use of waterless alcohol
based antiseptics since alcohol does
not have sporicidal activity.
Pulmonary Anthrax
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Environmental Anthrax:
aerosolizable spore-containing
powder or other substance
R
Abscess
Adenovirus infection (see agentspecific guidance under
gastroenteritis, conjunctivitis,
pneumonia)
DE
Until decontamination of environment
complete. Wear respirator (N95 mask
or PAPRs), protective clothing;
decontaminate persons with powder on
them.
Hand hygiene: Handwashing for 30-60
seconds with soap and water or 2%
chlorhexidine gluconate after spore
contact (alcohol based hand rubs
inactive against spores).
Post-exposure prophylaxis following
environmental exposure: 60 days of
antimicrobials (either doxycycline or
ciprofloxacin) and post-exposure
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 185
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
vaccine under IND.
Antibiotic-associated colitis (see
Clostridium difficile)
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms
(AROs), infection or colonization (e.g.
MRSA, VRE, VISA/VRSA, ESBLs,
resistant S. pneumoniae)
R/C
Arthropod-borne viral encephalitides
(eastern, western, Venezuelan
equine encephalomyelitis; St. Louis,
California encephalitis; West Nile
Virus) and viral fevers (dengue,
yellow fever, Colorado tick fever)
R
Not transmitted from person to person
except rarely by transfusion, and for
West Nile virus by organ transplant,
breastmilk or transplacentally. Install
screens in windows and doors in
endemic areas. Use DEET-containing
mosquito repellents and clothing to
cover extremities.
Ascariasis
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Aspergillosis
R
Contact Precautions and Airborne
Precautions if massive soft tissue
infection with copious drainage and
repeated irrigations required.
Babesiosis
R
Not transmitted from person to person
except rarely by transfusion.
Blastomycosis, North American,
cutaneous or pulmonary
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Botulism
R
Bronchiolitis (see respiratory
infections in infants and young
children)
C
Brucellosis (undulant, Malta,
Mediterranean fever)
R
AROs judged by the Infection
Prevention and Control Program, based
on local, provincial or national
recommendations, to be of clinical and
epidemiologic significance. Contact
Precautions recommended in settings
with evidence of ongoing transmission,
acute care settings with increased risk
for transmission or wounds that cannot
be contained by dressings.
Avian influenza (see influenza, avian,
below)
Not transmitted from person to person.
DI
Use mask according to Routine
Practices. (Droplet precautions if
patient coughing).
Not transmitted from person to person
except rarely via banked spermatozoa
and sexual contact. Provide
antimicrobial prophylaxis following
laboratory exposure and monitor
serology.
Campylobacter gastroenteritis (see
gastroenteritis)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 186
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Candidiasis, all forms including
mucocutaneous
R
Cat-scratch fever (benign inoculation
lymphoreticulosis)
R
Cellulitis
R
Chancroid (soft chancre) (H.ducreyi)
R
Chickenpox (see varicella)
A
Duration
Comments
Not transmitted from person to person.
Transmitted sexually from person to
person.
Chlamydia trachomatis
Conjunctivitis
R
Genital
(lymphogranuloma Venereum)
R
Pneumonia (infants 3 months
of age or less)
R
R
Outbreaks in institutionalized
populations reported, rarely.
Open drain in place;
limited or minor drainage
R
Contact Precautions if there is copious
uncontained drainage.
No drain or closed drainage
system in place
R
Chlamydia pneumoniae
Cholera (see Gastroenteritis)
Closed-cavity infection
Clostridium
C. botulinum
R
C. difficile (see Gastroenteritis)
C
Not transmitted from person to person
DI
C. perfringens
Food poisoning
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Gas gangrene
R
Transmission from person to person
rare; one outbreak in a surgical setting
reported. Use Contact Precautions if
wound drainage is extensive.
Draining lesions
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Pneumonia
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Colorado tick fever
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Congenital rubella
C
Coccidioidomycosis (valley fever)
Until 1 year
of age
Routine Practices if nasopharyngeal
and urine cultures repeatedly negative
after 3 months of age.
Conjunctivitis
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 187
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Acute bacterial
R
Chlamydia
R
Gonococcal
R
Acute viral (acute hemorrhagic)
C
Duration
Comments
DI
Adenovirus most common; Enterovirus
70, Coxsackie virus A24, also
associated with community outbreaks.
Highly contagious; outbreaks in eye
clinics, pediatric and neonatal settings,
institutional settings reported. Eye
clinics should follow Routine Practices
when handling patients/residents with
conjunctivitis. Routine use of infection
prevention and control measures in the
handling of instruments and equipment,
and disinfection of eye equipment
between patients/residents, will prevent
the occurrence of outbreaks in this and
other settings.
Corona virus associated with SARS
(SARS-CoV) (see severe acute
respiratory syndrome)
Coxsackie virus disease (see
enteroviral infection)
Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease
(CJD, vCJD)
R
Use disposable instruments or special
sterilization/ disinfection for surfaces,
objects contaminated with neural tissue
if CJD or vCJD suspected and has not
been ruled out; No special burial
procedures.
Croup (see respiratory infections in
infants and young children)
Crimean-Congo Fever (see Viral
Hemorrhagic Fever)
R
Cryptococcosis
R
Cryptosporidiosis (see also
gastroenteritis)
C
Cysticercosis
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Cytomegalovirus infection, including
in neonates and immunosuppressed
patients/residents.
R
No additional precautions for pregnant
Healthcare Workers (requires saliva
contact for transmission).
Decubitus ulcer (see pressure ulcer)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Dengue fever
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Not transmitted from person to person.
Page 188
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Comments
Type
Duration
Cutaneous
C
CN
Until 2 cultures taken 24 hrs apart
negative
Pharyngeal
D
CN
Until on appropriate treatment and 2
cultures taken 24 hrs apart negative.
Diarrhea, acute-infective etiology
suspected (see gastroenteritis)
Diphtheria
Ebola virus (see viral hemorrhagic
fevers)
Echinococcosis (hydatidosis)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Echovirus (see enteroviral infection)
Encephalitis or encephalomyelitis
(see specific etiologic agents)
Endometritis (endomyometritis)
R
Enterobiasis (pinworm disease,
oxyuriasis)
R
Enterococcus species (see multidrugresistant organisms if
epidemiologically significant or
vancomycin resistant)
Enterocolitis, C. difficile (see C.
difficile, gastroenteritis)
Enteroviral infections (i.e. Group A
and B Coxsackie viruses and Echo
viruses) (excludes polio virus)
R
Epiglottitis, due to Haemophilus
influenzae type b
D
Epstein-Barr virus infection, including
infectious mononucleosis
R
Use Contact Precautions for diapered
or incontinent children for duration of
illness and to control institutional
outbreaks.
U 24 hrs
Erythema Infectiosum (also see
Parvovirus B19)
See specific disease agents for
epiglottitis due to other etiologies)
Pregnant staff should not provide care.
Escherichia coli gastroenteritis (see
gastroenteritis)
Food poisoning
Botulism
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
C. perfringens or welchii
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Staphylococcal
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 189
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Furunculosis, staphylococcal
Infants and young children
Duration
R
C
Comments
Contact Precautions if drainage not
controlled. Follow institutional policies
if MRSA.
DI
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
C/D
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks for gastroenteritis caused by
all of the agents below.
Adenovirus
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
Campylobacter species
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
Cholera (Vibrio cholerae)
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
C. difficile
C
DI
Cryptosporidium species
C
DI
Gangrene (gas gangrene)
Gastroenteritis
Discontinue antibiotics if possible. Do
not share electronic thermometers;
ensure consistent environmental
cleaning and disinfection. Hypochlorite
solutions are required for cleaning for
all cases. Handwashing with soap and
water preferred because of the
absence of sporicidal activity of alcohol
in alcohol-based hand rubs.
E. coli
Enteropathogenic
O157:H7 and other shiga
toxin-producing strains
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
Other species
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
Giardia lamblia
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 190
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Comments
Type
Duration
C/D
DI
Use Contact Precautions for all infected
and exposed cases for the duration of
illness and to control institutional
outbreaks. Persons who clean areas
heavily contaminated with feces or
vomitus may benefit from wearing
masks since virus can be aerosolized
from these body substances; ensure
consistent environmental cleaning and
disinfection with focus on bathrooms
even when apparently unsoiled.
Hypochlorite solutions are required for
cleaning for all cases. Alcohol is less
active, but there is no evidence that
alcohol based hand rubs are not
effective for hand decontamination.
Cohorting of affected patients/residents
to separate airspaces and toilet
facilities may help interrupt
transmission during outbreaks.
Rotavirus
C
DI
Ensure consistent environmental
cleaning and disinfection and frequent
removal of soiled diapers. Prolonged
shedding may occur in both
immunocompetent and
immunocompromised children and the
elderly.
Salmonella species (including
S. typhi)
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
Shigella species
(Bacillary dysentery)
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
Vibrio parahaemolyticus
R
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
C/D
Use Contact Precautions for incontinent
persons of any age for the duration of
illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
outbreaks.
Noroviruses
Viral (if not covered elsewhere)
Yersinia enterocolitica
R
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Use Contact Precautions for diapered
or incontinent persons for the duration
Page 191
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
of illness or to control institutional
outbreaks.
German measles (see rubella; see
congenital rubells)
Giardiasis (see gastroenteritis)
Gonococcal Ophthalmia neonatorum
(gonorrheal Ophthalmia, acute
conjunctivitis of newborn)
R
Gonorrhea
Granuloma inguinale (Donovanosis,
granuloma venereum)
R
Guillain-Barré syndrome
Not an infectious condition.
Haemophilus influenzae (see
disease-specific recommendations)
Hand, foot and mouth disease (see
enteroviral infection)
Hansen‘s Disease (see Leprosy)
Hantavirus pulmonary syndrome
R
Helicobacter pylori
R
Not transmitted from person to person
Hepatitis, viral
Type A
R
Provide Hepatitis A vaccine postexposure as recommended by Public
Health.
Incontinent patients/residents
with diarrhea
C
Maintain Contact Precautions in infants
and children less than 3 years of age
for duration of hospitalization; for
children 3 – 14 years of age for 2
weeks after onset of symptoms; more
than 14 years of age for 1 week after
onset of symptoms.
Type B – HbsAg positive; acute
or chronic
R
See specific recommendations for care
of patients/residents in hemodialysis
centres
Type C and other unspecified
non-A, non-B
R
See specific recommendations for care
of patients/residents in hemodialysis
centres.
Type D (seen only with
hepatitis B)
R
Type E
R
Type G
R
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Use Contact Precautions for all
symptomatic individuals and incontinent
individuals for the duration of illness.
Page 192
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
Herpangina (see enteroviral infection)
Hookworm
R
Herpes simplex (Herpesvirus
hominis)
Encephalitis
R
Mucocutaneous, disseminated
or primary, severe
C
Until lesions
dry and
crusted
Mucocutaneous, recurrent
(skin, oral, genital)
C
Until lesions
dry and
crusted
Neonatal
C
Until lesions
dry and
crusted
Disseminated disease in any
patient.
Localized disease in immunocompromised patient until
disseminated infection ruled out
A/C
DI
Susceptible healthcare workers should
not enter room if immune caregivers
are available; no recommendation for
protection of immune healthcare
workers; no recommendation for type of
protection, i.e. surgical mask or
respirator, for susceptible healthcare
workers.
Localized in patient with intact
immune system with lesions
that can be contained/ covered.
R
DI
Susceptible healthcare workers should
not provide direct patient care when
other immune caregivers are available.
Also, for asymptomatic, exposed
infants delivered vaginally or by CSection and if mother has active
infection and membranes have been
ruptured for more than 4 to 6 hrs until
infant surface cultures obtained at 2436 hrs of age are negative.
Herpes zoster (varicella-zoster)
(shingles)
Histoplasmosis
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Human immunodeficiency virus (HIV)
R
Post-exposure chemoprophylaxis for
some blood and body fluid exposures.
Human metapneumovirus
C
DI
Impetigo
C
U 24 hrs
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
HAI reported, but route of transmission
not established. Assumed to be
Contact / Droplet transmission as for
RSV since the viruses are closely
related and have similar clinical
manifestations and epidemiology.
Wear masks according to Routine
Practices.
Page 193
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Infectious mononucleosis
Duration
Comments
5 days except
Single patient room when available or
cohort; avoid placement with high-risk
patients/residents; mask patient when
transported out of room;
chemoprophylaxis / vaccine to control /
prevent outbreaks. Use gown and
gloves according to Routine Practices;
may be especially important in pediatric
settings. Duration of precautions for
immuno-compromised
patients/residents cannot be defined;
prolonged duration of viral shedding
(i.e. for several weeks) has been
observed; implications for transmission
are unknown.
R
Influenza
Human (seasonal influenza)
D
DI in immunocompromised
persons
Avian (e.g. H5N1, H7, H9
strains)
Pandemic influenza
(also a human influenza virus)
See
www.cdc.gov/flu/avian/professional/infe
ct-control.htm for current avian
influenza guidance.
D
5 days
Kawasaki syndrome
See http://www.pandemicflu.gov for
current pandemic influenza guidance.
Not an infectious condition.
Lassa fever (see viral hemorrhagic
fevers)
Legionnaires‘ disease
Not transmitted from person to person.
Leprosy
R
Leptospirosis
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Lice
http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/dpd/parasite
s/lice/default.htm
Head (Pediculosis)
C
Body
R
Transmitted person to person through
infested clothing. Wear gown and
gloves when removing clothing; bag
and wash clothes according to CDC
guidance above.
Pubic
R
Transmitted person to person through
sexual contact.
Listeriosis (listeria monocytogenes)
R
Person-to-person transmission rare;
cross-transmission in neonatal settings
and endoscopy.
Lyme disease
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
U 4 hrs
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 194
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Lymphocytic choriomeningitis
R
Lymphogranuloma venereum
R
Malaria
R
Duration
Comments
Not transmitted from person to person.
Not transmitted from person to person
except through transfusion rarely and
through a failure to follow Routine
Practices during patient care. Install
screens in windows and doors in
endemic areas. Use DEET-containing
mosquito repellents and clothing to
cover extremities.
Marburg virus disease (see viral
hemorrhagic fevers)
Measles (rubeola)
A
Melioidosis, all forms
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Aseptic (nonbacterial or viral;
also see enteroviral infections)
R
Contact Precautions for infants and
young children.
Bacterial, gram-negative
enteric,
in neonates
R
Fungal
R
Haemophilus influenzae, type
B, known or suspected
D
Listeria monocytogenes
(See Listeriosis)
R
Neisseria meningitidis
(meningococcal) known or
D
4 days after
onset of
rash;
DI in
immunocompromised
Susceptible healthcare workers should
not enter room if immune care
providers are available; no
recommendation for face protection for
immune healthcare worker; no
recommendation for type of face
protection for susceptible healthcare
workers, i.e. mask or respirator. For
exposed susceptibles, post-exposure
vaccine within 72 hrs or immune
globulin within 6 days when available.
Place exposed susceptible
patients/residents on Airborne
Precautions and exclude susceptible
healthcare workers from duty from day
5 after first exposure to day 21 after last
exposure, regardless of post-exposure
vaccine.
Meningitis
U 24 hrs
U 24 hrs
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
See meningococcal disease below
Page 195
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
suspected
Streptococcus pneumoniae
R
M. tuberculosis
R
Other diagnosed bacterial
R
Meningococcal disease: sepsis,
pneumonia, meningitis
D
Molluscum contagiosum
R
Monkeypox
Mucormycosis
A/C
Concurrent, active pulmonary disease
or draining cutaneous lesions may
necessitate addition of Contact and/or
Airborne Precautions. For children,
Airborne Precautions until active
tuberculosis ruled out in visiting family
members (see tuberculosis below).
U 24 hrs
Post-exposure chemoprophylaxis and
immunoprophylaxis for household
contacts, healthcare workers exposed
to respiratory secretions.
A-Until
monkeypox
confirmed and
smallpox
excluded;
C-Until lesions
crusted
See www.cdc.gov/ncidod/monkeypox
for most current recommendations.
Transmission in hospital settings
unlikely. Pre- and post-exposure
smallpox vaccine recommended for
exposed healthcare workers.
R
Multidrug-resistant organisms
(MDROs)
(See Antibiotic Resistant Organisms)
Mumps (infectious parotitis)
D
U 9 days
Mycobacteria, non-tuberculosis
(atypical)
After onset of swelling susceptible
healthcare workers should not provide
care if immune caregivers are
available.
Note: Recent assessment of outbreaks
in health 18-24 year olds has indicated
that salivary viral shedding occurred
early in the course of illness and that 5
days of Additional Precautions after
onset of parotitis may be appropriate in
community settings; however, the
implications for healthcare personnel
and high-risk patient populations
remain to be clarified.
Not transmitted from person to person.
Pulmonary
R
Wound
R
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 196
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Comments
Type
Duration
Mycoplasma pneumonia
D
DI
Necrotizing enterocolitis
R
Contact Precautions when cases
clustered temporally.
Nocardiosis, draining lesions, or other
presentations
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Norovirus (see gastroenteritis)
Norwalk agent gastroenteritis (see
gastroenteritis)
Orf
R
Parainfluenza virus infection,
respiratory in infants and young
children
C
Parvovirus B19 (Erythema
Infectiosum)
D
Pediculosis (lice)
C
U 24 hrs
after
treatment
Pertussis (whooping cough)
D
U 5 days
Single patient room preferred.
Cohorting an option. Post-exposure
chemoprophylaxis for household
contacts and healthcare workers with
prolonged exposure to respiratory
secretions.
Recommendations for Tdap vaccine in
adults (pediatric nurses, doctors) under
development.
Pinworm infection (Enterobiasis)
R
DI
Viral shedding may be prolonged in
immuno-suppressed patients/residents.
Maintain precautions for duration of
hospitalization when chronic disease
occurs in an immuno-compromised
patient. For patients/residents with
transient aplastic crisis or red-cell crisis,
maintain precautions for 7 days.
Duration of precautions for immunosuppressed patients/residents with
persistently positive PCR not defined,
but transmission has occurred.
Pregnant staff should not provide care.
Plague (Yersinia pestis)
Bubonic
R
Pneumonic
D
U 48 hrs
Antimicrobial prophylaxis for exposed
healthcare worker.
D/C
DI
Outbreaks in pediatric and institutional
settings reported. In immuno-
Pneumonia
Adenovirus
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 197
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
compromised hosts, extend duration of
Droplet and Contact Precautions due to
prolonged shedding of virus.
Bacterial not listed elsewhere
(including gram-negative
bacterial)
R
B. cepacia in patients/residents
with Cystic Fibrosis (CF),
including respiratory tract
colonization
C
Avoid exposure to other persons with
CF; private room preferred, including
clinic visits. Criteria for discontinuing
Precautions not established. Use
Precautions for duration of
hospitalization if other CF
patients/residents on the unit. See CF
Foundation guideline.
B. cepacia in patients/residents
without Cystic Fibrosis (see
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms)
Chlamydia
R
Fungal
R
Haemophilus influenzae,
type b
Adults
R
Infants and children
C
U 24 hrs
Legionella spp.
R
Meningococcal
D
U 24 hrs
Mycoplasma (primary atypical
pneumonia)
D
DI
Pneumococcal pneumonia
R
Pneumocystis jiroveci
(Pneumocystis carinii)
R
Staphylococcus aureus
R
See meningococcal disease above
Multidrug resistant bacterial
(see Antibiotic Resistant
Organisms)
Streptococcus, group A
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Use Droplet Precautions if evidence of
transmission within a patient care unit
or facility.
For MRSA, see Antibiotic Resistant
Organisms
For Invasive Group A Streptococcus,
Contact or Droplet Precautions for 24
hrs until appropriate antibiotic treatment
given. Includes pneumonia, toxic
shock syndrome, necrotizing fasciitis,
but not cellulitis.
Page 198
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Comments
Type
Duration
Adults
D
U 24 hrs
See streptococcal disease (group A
streptococcus) below.
Contact Precautions if skin lesions
present.
Infants and young
children
D
U 24 hrs
Contact Precautions if skin lesions
present.
Varicella-zoster (See Varicellazoster)
Viral
Adults
R
Infants and young
children (see respiratory
infectious disease, acute,
or specific viral agent)
C
DI
Major
C
DI
Minor or limited
R
If dressing covers and contains
drainage.
Psittacosis (ornithosis) (Chlamydia
psittaci)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Q fever
R
Rabies
R
Person to person transmission rare;
transmission via corneal, tissue and
organ transplants has been reported. If
patient has bitten another individual or
saliva has contaminated an open
wound or mucous membrane, wash
exposed area thoroughly and
administer post-exposure prophylaxis.
Rat-bite fever (Streptobacillus
moniliformis disease, Spirillum minus
disease)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Relapsing fever
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Poliomyelitis
Pressure ulcer (Decubitus ulcer,
pressure sore) infected
If no dressing or containment of
drainage – until drainage stops or can
be contained by dressing.
Prion disease (See Creutzfeld-Jacob
Disease)
Resistant bacterial infection or
colonization (see Antibiotic Resistant
Organisms)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 199
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
Respiratory infectious disease, acute
(if not covered elsewhere)
Adults
R
Infants and young children
C
DI
Respiratory syncytial virus infection,
in infants, young children and
immuno-compromised adults
C
DI
Reye‘s syndrome
R
Not an infectious condition.
Rheumatic fever
R
Not an infectious condition.
Rhinovirus
D
Rickettsial fevers, tickborne (Rocky
Mountain spotted fever, tickborne
typhus fever)
R
Not transmitted from person to person
except through transfusion, rarely.
Rickettsialpox (vesicular rickettsiosis)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Ringworm (Dermatophytosis,
dermatomycosis, tinea)
R
Rarely, outbreaks have occurred in
healthcare settings (e.g. NICU,
rehabilitation hospital. Use Contact
Precautions for outbreak.
Ritter‘s disease (staphylococcal
scalded skin syndrome)
C
Rocky Mountain spotted fever
R
Roseola infantum (exanthem
subitum; caused by HHV-6)
R
DI
DI
Wear mask according to Routine
Practices. In immuno-compromised
patients/residents, extend the duration
of Contact Precautions due to
prolonged shedding.
Droplet most important route of
transmission. Outbreaks have
occurred in NICUs and LTCFs. Add
Contact Precautions if copious moist
secretions and close contact likely to
occur (e.g. young infants).
See staphylococcal disease, scalded
skin syndrome below.
Not transmitted from person to person
except through transfusion, rarely.
Rotavirus infection (see
gastroenteritis)
Rubella (German measles) (also see
congenital rubella)
D
U 7 days
after onset of
rash
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Susceptible healthcare workers should
not enter room if immune caregivers
are available. No recommendation for
wearing face protection (e.g. a surgical
mask) if immune. Pregnant women
who are not immune should not care for
these patients/residents. Administer
vaccine within three days of exposure
to non-pregnant susceptible individuals.
Place exposed susceptible
Page 200
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
patients/residents on Droplet
Precautions; exclude susceptible
healthcare personnel from duty from
day 5 after first exposure to day 21
after last exposure, regardless of postexposure vaccine.
Rubeola (see measles)
Salmonellosis (see gastroenteritis)
Scabies
C
U 24 hrs
following
treatment
Scalded skin syndrome,
staphylococcal
C
DI
Schistosomiasis (bilharziasis)
R
Severe acute respiratory syndrome
(SARS)
A/D/C
DI
plus 10 days
after resolution
of fever,
provided
respiratory
symptoms are
absent or
improving
See staphylococcal disease, scalded
skin syndrome below.
Airborne Precautions preferred; Droplet
Precautions if Airborne Infection
Isolation Room unavailable. N95 or
higher respiratory protection; surgical
mask if N95 unavailable; eye protection
(goggles, face shield); aerosolgenerating procedures and ―super
shedders‖ highest risk for transmission
via small droplet nuclei and large
droplets. Vigilant environmental
disinfection. (See
www.cdc.gov/ncidod/sars)
Shigellosis (see gastroenteritis)
Smallpox (variola; see vaccinia for
management of vaccinated persons)
A/C
Sporotrichosis
R
Spirillum minor disease (rat-bite
fever)
R
DI
Until all scabs have crusted and
separated (3–4 weeks). Nonvaccinated healthcare workers should
not provide care when immune
healthcare workers are available; N95
or higher respiratory protection for
susceptible and successfully
vaccinated individuals; post-exposure
vaccine within 4 days of exposure
protective.
Not transmitted from person to person.
Staphylococcal disease (S. aureus)
Skin, wound, or burn
Major
C
DI
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
No dressing or dressing does not
contain drainage adequately.
Page 201
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Minor or limited
Duration
R
Comments
Dressing covers and contains drainage
adequately.
Multi-drug resistant (see
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms)
Pneumonia
R
Scalded skin syndrome
C
Toxic shock syndrome
R
Streptobacillus moniliformis disease
(rat-bite fever)
R
DI
Consider healthcare personnel as
potential source of nursery, NICU
outbreak.
Not transmitted from person to person
Streptococcal disease (group A
streptococcus)
Invasive Group A
Streptococcus (iGAS)
(including pneumonia, toxic
shock syndrome, necrotizing
fasciitis, but not cellulitis)
D
U 24 hrs
Outbreaks of serious invasive disease
have occurred secondary to
transmission among patients/residents
and healthcare personnel. Contact
Precautions for draining wounds as
below; follow recommendations for
antimicrobial prophylaxis in selected
conditions.
C/D
U 24 hrs
No dressing or dressing does not
contain drainage adequately
Skin, wound, or burn
Major
Minor or limited
R
Dressing covers and contains drainage
adequately
Endometritis (puerperal sepsis)
R
Pharyngitis in infants and
young children
D
U 24 hrs
Pneumonia
D
U 24 hrs
Scarlet fever in infants and
young children
D
U 24 hrs
Streptococcal disease (group B
streptococcus), neonatal
R
Streptococcal disease (not
group A or B) unless covered
elsewhere
R
Multidrug-resistant (see
Antibiotic Resistant Organisms)
Strongyloidiasis
R
Syphilis
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 202
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
Latent (tertiary) and
seropositivity without lesions
R
Skin and mucous membrane,
including congenital
R
Contact Precautions for primary or
secondary stage of disease.
Hymenolepsis nana
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Taenia solium (pork)
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Other
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Tetanus
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Tinea (e.g. Dermatophytosis,
dermatomycosis, ringworm)
R
Rare episodes of person-to-person
transmission.
Toxoplasmosis
R
Transmission from person to person is
rare; vertical transmission from mother
to child, transmission through organs
and blood transfusion rare.
Toxic shock syndrome
(staphylococcal disease,
streptococcal disease)
R
Droplet Precautions for the first 24 hrs
after implementation of antibiotic
therapy if Group A streptococcus is a
likely etiology.
Trachoma, acute
R
Tapeworm disease
Transmissible spongiform
encephalopathy (see CreutzfeldJacob disease, CJD, vCJD)
Trench mouth (Vincent‘s angina)
R
Trichinosis
R
Trichomoniasis
R
Trichuriasis (whipworm disease)
R
Tuberculosis (M. tuberculosis)
A/C
Discontinue precautions only when
patient is improving clinically, and
drainage has ceased or there are three
consecutive (one week apart) negative
cultures of continued drainage.
Examine for evidence of active
pulmonary tuberculosis.
Extrapulmonary, no draining
lesion, meningitis
R
Examine for evidence of pulmonary
tuberculosis. For infants and children,
use Airborne Precautions until active
pulmonary tuberculosis in visiting family
members ruled out.
Pulmonary or laryngeal
disease, confirmed
A
Discontinue precautions only after
consultation with Infection Prevention &
Extrapulmonary, draining lesion
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 203
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
Control Practitioner (minimum of 2
weeks on treatment, clinical
improvement, and three consecutive
sputum smears negative for acid-fast
bacilli collected on separate days).
Reference BCCDC.
Pulmonary or laryngeal
disease, suspected
A
Skin-test positive with no
evidence of current active
disease
R
Discontinue precautions only when the
likelihood of infectious TB disease is
deemed negligible, and either 1) there
is another diagnosis that explains the
clinical syndrome, or 2) the results of
three sputum or BAL smears for AFB
are negative. Each of the three
specimens should be collected 24 hrs
apart, preferably early each morning.
Tularemia
Draining lesion
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Pulmonary
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Rickettsia prowazekii (Epidemic
or Louse-borne typhus)
R
Transmitted from person to person
through close personal or clothing
contact.
Rickettsia typhi
R
Not transmitted from person to person.
Typhoid (Salmonella typhi) fever (see
gastroenteritis)
Typhus
Urinary tract infection (including
pyelonephritis), with or without
urinary catheter
R
Vaccinia (vaccination site, adverse
events following vaccination)
Vaccination site care (including
autoinoculated areas)
Only vaccinated healthcare workers
have contact with active vaccination
sites and care for persons with adverse
vaccinia events; if unvaccinated, only
healthcare workers without
contraindications to vaccine may
provide care.
R
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Vaccination recommended for
vaccinators; for newly vaccinated
healthcare workers: semi-permeable
dressing over gauze until scab
separates, with dressing change as
fluid accumulates, approx. 3–5 days;
Page 204
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
gloves, hand hygiene for dressing
change; vaccinated healthcare worker
or healthcare worker without
contraindication to vaccine for dressing
changes.
Eczema vaccinatum
C
Fetal vaccinia
C
Generalized vaccinia
C
Progressive vaccinia
C
Until lesions
dry and
crusted,
scabs
separated
For contact with virus-containing
lesions and exudative material
Post vaccinia encephalitis
Blepharitis or conjunctivitis
R/C
Iritis or keratitis
R
Vaccinia-associated erythema
multiforme (Stevens Johnson
Syndrome)
R
Secondary bacterial infection
(e.g. S. aureus, group A beta
hemolytic streptococcus)
R/C
Varicella Zoster
Use Contact Precautions if there is
copious drainage.
Not an infectious condition.
A/C
Follow organism-specific (strep, staph
most frequent) recommendations and
consider magnitude of drainage.
Until lesions
dry and
crusted
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Susceptible healthcare workers should
not enter room if immune caregivers
are available; no recommendation for
face protection of immune healthcare
workers; no recommendation for type of
protection, i.e. surgical mask or
respirator for susceptible healthcare
workers. In immuno-compromised host
with varicella pneumonia, prolong
duration of precautions for duration of
illness. Post-exposure prophylaxis:
provide post-exposure vaccine ASAP
but within 120 hours; for susceptible
exposed persons for whom vaccine is
contraindicated (immuno-compromised
persons, pregnant women, newborns
whose mother‘s varicella onset is 5
days or less before delivery or within 48
hrs after delivery) provide VZIG, when
available, within 96 hours; if
unavailable, use IVIG; Use Airborne
Precautions for exposed susceptible
persons and exclude exposed
susceptible healthcare workers
beginning 8 days after first exposure
Page 205
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Duration
Comments
until 21 days after last exposure or 28
days if received VZIG, regardless of
post-exposure vaccination.
Variola (see smallpox)
Vibrio parahaemolyticus (see
gastroenteritis)
Vincent‘s angina (trench mouth)
R
Viral hemorrhagic fevers, due to
Lassa, Ebola, Marburg, CrimeanCongo fever viruses
A
DI
Single-patient negative pressure room
preferred. Emphasize: 1) use of
sharps safety devices and safe work
practices; 2) hand hygiene; 3) barrier
protection against blood and body fluids
upon entry into room (single gloves and
fluid-resistant or impermeable gown,
face/eye protection with masks,
goggles or face shields); and 4)
appropriate waste handling. Use N95
or higher respirators when performing
aerosol-generating procedures.
Largest viral load in final stages of
illness when hemorrhage may occur;
additional PPE, including double
gloves, leg and shoe coverings may be
used, especially in resource-limited
settings where options for cleaning and
laundry are limited. Notify public health
officials immediately if Ebola is
suspected.
No dressing or dressing does not
contain drainage adequately.
Viral respiratory diseases (not
covered elsewhere
Adults
R
Infants and young children (see
respiratory infectious disease,
acute)
Whooping cough (see pertussis)
Wound infections
Major
C
DI
Minor or limited
R
DI
Yersinia enterocolitica gastroenteritis
(see gastroenteritis)
Zoster (varicella-zoster) (see herpes
zoster)
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 206
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
TYPE AND DURATION OF ROUTINE PRACTICES AND
PRECAUTIONS RECOMMENDED FOR SELECTED INFECTIONS
AND CONDITIONS
Infection/Condition
Precautions
Type
Zygomycosis (phycomycosis,
mucormycosis)
Duration
R
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Comments
Not transmitted from person to person.
Page 207
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
APPENDIX B: Glossary of Terms
Admission Restrictions – any restrictions placed on unit during an outbreak that limits the
normal admission pattern (e.g. no off-service admissions to a unit)
Aseptic technique. The measures taken to purposefully reduce the number of
microorganisms (germs) to an irreducible number for the purpose of preventing transmission
of infection. These include handwashing, disinfection and sterilization
Antisepsis/Sanitation. This method of infection prevention and control includes using soap
and water to wash the hands and body as well as the use of antiseptics such as alcohol,
iodine and betadine to clean the skin for medical procedures, as these inhibit the growth of
pathogenic microorganisms. This level of asepsis may kill or inhibit some microbes but is
generally not effective against spores.
American Institute of Architects. A professional organization that develops standards for
building ventilation, The ―2001Guidelines for Design and Construction of Hospital and Health
Care Facilities‖, the development of which was supported by the AIA, Academy of
Architecture for Health, Facilities Guideline Institute, with assistance from the U.S.
Department of Health and Human Services and the National Institutes of Health, is the
primary source of guidance for creating airborne infection isolation rooms (AIIRs) and
protective environments.
Ambulatory care settings. Facilities that provide healthcare to patients/residents who do
not remain overnight (e.g. hospital-based outpatient clinics, nonhospital-based clinics and
physician offices, urgent care centers, surgicenters, free-standing dialysis centers, public
health clinics, imaging centers, ambulatory behavioral health and substance abuse clinics,
physical therapy and rehabilitation centers, dental practices and outpatient clinics.
Antibiotic Resistant organisms (AROs). Also known as multidrug resistant organisms
(MDRO). In general, bacteria that are resistant to several classes of antimicrobial agents and
usually are resistant to most commercially available antimicrobial agents (e.g. MRSA, VRE,
extended spectrum beta-lactamase [ESBL]-producing or intrinsically resistant gram-negative
bacilli).
Bed closure – a bed space is closed to admissions or transfers in
Bioaerosols. An airborne dispersion of particles containing whole or parts of biological
entities, such as bacteria, viruses, dust mites, fungal hyphae, or fungal spores. Such
aerosols usually consist of a mixture of mono-dispersed and aggregate cells, spores or
viruses, carried by other materials, such as respiratory secretions and/or inert particles.
Infectious bioaerosols (i.e. those that contain biological agents capable of causing an
infectious disease) can be generated from human sources (e.g. expulsion from the respiratory
tract during coughing, sneezing, talking or singing; during suctioning or wound irrigation), wet
environmental sources (e.g. HVAC and cooling tower water with Legionella) or dry sources
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 208
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
(e.g. construction dust with spores produced by Aspergillus spp.). Bioaerosols include large
respiratory droplets and small droplet nuclei (Cole EC. AJIC 1998;26: 453-64).
Caregivers. All persons who are not employees of an organization, are not paid, and provide
or assist in providing healthcare to a patient (e.g. family member, friend) and acquire
technical training as needed based on the tasks that must be performed.
Cohorting. In the context of this guideline, this term applies to the practice of grouping
patients/residents infected or colonized with the same infectious agent together to confine
their care to one area and prevent contact with susceptible patients/residents (cohorting
patients/residents). During outbreaks, healthcare personnel may be assigned to a cohort of
patients/residents to further limit opportunities for transmission (cohorting staff).
Colonization. An individual who has been found to be culture positive at one or more body
sites but who has no signs or symptoms of infection.
Disinfection: The process of using chemical agents or boiling water to destroy or kill
pathogenic microbes.
Droplet nuclei. Microscopic particles more than 5 microns in size that are the residue of
evaporated droplets and are produced when a person coughs, sneezes, shouts, or sings.
These particles can remain suspended in the air for prolonged periods of time and can be
carried on normal air currents in a room or beyond, to adjacent spaces or areas receiving
exhaust air.
Engineering controls. Removal or isolation of a workplace hazard through technology.
AIIRs, a Protective Environment, engineered sharps injury prevention devices and sharps
containers are examples of engineering controls.
Epidemiologically important pathogens. Infectious agents that have one or more of the
following characteristics: 1) are readily transmissible; 2) have a proclivity toward causing
outbreaks; 3) may be associated with a severe outcome; or 4) are difficult to treat. Examples
include Acinetobacter sp., Aspergillus sp., Burkholderia cepacia, Clostridium difficile,
Klebsiella or Enterobacter sp., extended-spectrum-beta-lactamase producing gram negative
bacilli [ESBLs], methicillin-resistant Staphylococcus aureus [MRSA], Pseudomonas
aeruginosa, vancomycin-resistant enterococci [VRE], methicillin resistant Staphylococcus
aureus [MRSA], vancomycin resistant Staphylococcus aureus [VRSA] influenza virus,
respiratory syncytial virus [RSV], rotavirus, SARS CoV, noroviruses and the hemorrhagic
fever viruses).
Hand hygiene. A general term that applies to any one of the following: 1) handwashing with
plain (nonantimicrobial) soap and water); 2) antiseptic hand rub (waterless antiseptic product,
most often alcohol-based, rubbed on all surfaces of hands); or 3) surgical hand antisepsis
(antiseptic hand wash or antiseptic hand rub performed preoperatively by surgical personnel
to eliminate transient hand flora and reduce resident hand flora).
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 209
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Healthcare-associated infection (HAI). An infection that develops in a patient who is cared
for in any setting where healthcare is delivered (e.g. acute care hospital, chronic care facility,
ambulatory clinic, dialysis center, surgicenter) and is related to receiving healthcare (i.e. was
not incubating or present at the time healthcare was provided). In ambulatory and home
settings, HAI would apply to any infection that is associated with a medical or surgical
intervention within the previous one year. Since the geographic location of infection
acquisition is often uncertain, the preferred term is considered to be healthcare-associated
rather than healthcare-acquired.
Healthcare personnel, healthcare worker (HCW). All paid and unpaid persons who work in
a healthcare setting (e.g. any person who has professional or technical training in a
healthcare-related field and provides patient care in a healthcare setting or any person who
provides services that support the delivery of healthcare such as dietary, housekeeping,
engineering, maintenance personnel).
Hematopoietic stem cell transplantation (HSCT). Any transplantation of blood or bone
marrow-derived hematopoietic stem cells, regardless of donor type (e.g. allogeneic or
autologous) or cell source (e.g. bone marrow, peripheral blood, or placental/umbilical cord
blood); associated with periods of severe immunosuppression that vary with the source of the
cells, the intensity of chemotherapy required, and the presence of graft versus host disease
(MMWR 2000; 49: RR-10).
High-efficiency particulate air (HEPA) filter. An air filter that removes more than 99.97% of
particles more than 0.3 microns (the most penetrating particle size) at a specified flow rate of
air. HEPA filters may be integrated into the central air handling systems, installed at the point
of use above the ceiling of a room, or used as portable units (MMWR 2003; 52: RR-10).
Home care. A wide-range of medical, nursing, rehabilitation, hospice and social services
delivered to patients/residents in their place of residence (e.g. private residence, senior living
center, assisted living facility). Home health-care services include care provided by home
health aides and skilled nurses, respiratory therapists, dieticians, physicians, chaplains, and
volunteers; provision of durable medical equipment; home infusion therapy; and physical,
speech, and occupational therapy.
Immunocompromised patients/residents. Those patients/residents whose immune
mechanisms are deficient because of congenital or acquired immunologic disorders (e.g.
human immunodeficiency virus [HIV] infection, congenital immune deficiency syndromes),
chronic diseases such as diabetes mellitus, cancer, emphysema, or cardiac failure, ICU care,
malnutrition, and immunosuppressive therapy of another disease process [e.g. radiation,
cytotoxic chemotherapy, anti-graft-rejection medication, corticosteroids, monoclonal
antibodies directed against a specific component of the immune system]). The type of
infections for which an immunocompromised patient has increased susceptibility is
determined by the severity of immunosuppression and the specific component(s) of the
immune system that is affected. Patients/residents undergoing allogeneic HSCT and those
with chronic graft versus host disease are considered the most vulnerable to HAIs.
Immunocompromised states also make it more difficult to diagnose certain infections (e.g.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 210
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
tuberculosis) and are associated with more severe clinical disease states than persons with
the same infection and a normal immune system.
Infection. The condition when an organism (bacterial, viral, or parasitic) has entered a body
site, is multiplying in tissue, is causing the clinical manifestations of disease, such as fever,
suppurative wound, or pneumonia, and is documented by positive cultures, such as from
blood, sputum, wound or urine cultures
Infection Control Practitioner (ICP). A person whose primary training is in either nursing or
epidemiology and who has acquired special training in infection prevention and control.
Responsibilities may include collection, analysis, and feedback of infection data and trends to
healthcare providers; consultation on infection risk assessment, prevention and control
strategies; performance of education and training activities; implementation of evidencebased infection prevention and control practices or those mandated by regulatory and
licensing agencies; application of epidemiologic principles to improve patient outcomes;
participation in planning renovation and construction projects (e.g. to ensure appropriate
containment of construction dust); evaluation of new products or procedures on patient
outcomes; input into or collaboration with employee health services related to infection
prevention; implementation of preparedness plans; communication within the healthcare
setting, with local and Provincial health departments, and with the community at large
concerning infection prevention and control issues; and participation in research. Certification
in infection control (CIC) is available through the Certification Board for Infection Control.
Infection prevention and control program. A multidisciplinary program that includes a
group of activities to ensure that recommended practices for the prevention of healthcareassociated infections are implemented and followed by Healthcare Workers, making the
healthcare setting safe from infection for patients/residents and healthcare personnel. The
Joint Commission on Accreditation of Healthcare Organizations (JCAHO) requires the
following five components of an infection prevention and control program for accreditation: 1)
surveillance: monitoring patients/residents and healthcare personnel for acquisition of
infection and/or colonization; 2) investigation: identification and analysis of infection problems
or undesirable trends; 3) prevention: implementation of measures to prevent transmission of
infectious agents and to reduce risks for device- and procedure-related infections; 4) control:
evaluation and management of outbreaks; and 5) reporting: provision of information to
external agencies as required by local and Provincial law and regulation (www.jcaho.org).
The infection prevention and control program staff has the ultimate authority to determine
infection prevention and control policies for a healthcare organization with the approval of the
organization‘s governing body.
Long-term care facilities (LTCFs). An array of residential and outpatient facilities designed
to meet the bio-psychosocial needs of persons with sustained self-care deficits. These
include skilled nursing facilities, chronic disease hospitals, nursing homes, foster and group
homes, institutions for the developmentally disabled, residential care facilities, assisted living
facilities, retirement homes, adult day healthcare facilities, rehabilitation centers, and longterm
psychiatric hospitals.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 211
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Mask. A term that applies collectively to items used to cover the nose and mouth and
includes impermeable procedure masks, surgical masks, and N95 masks (respirators).
Negative Pressure Room (NPR). Also known as Airborne infection isolation room (AIIR), a
negative pressure room is a single-occupancy patient-care room used to isolate persons with
a suspected or confirmed airborne infectious disease. Environmental factors are controlled in
NPRs to minimize the transmission of infectious agents that are usually transmitted from
person to person by droplet nuclei associated with coughing or aerosolization of
contaminated fluids. Negative Pressure Rooms should provide negative pressure in the room
(so that air flows under the door gap into the room); and an air flow rate of 6–12 ACH (6 ACH
for existing structures, 12 ACH for new construction or renovation); and direct exhaust of air
from the room to the outside of the building or recirculation of air through a HEPA filter before
returning to circulation (MMWR 2005; 54 [RR-17]).
Nosocomial infection. A term that is derived from two Greek words ―nosos‖ (disease) and
―komeion‖ (to take care of) and refers to any infection that develops during or as a result of an
admission to an acute care facility (hospital) and was not incubating at the time of admission
(signs and symptoms of infection develop after 48 hours of admission).
Personal protective equipment (PPE). A variety of barriers used alone or in combination to
protect mucous membranes, skin, and clothing from contact with infectious agents. PPE
includes gloves, masks, respirators, goggles, face shields, and gowns.
Procedure Mask. A covering for the nose and mouth that is intended for use in general
patient care situations. These masks generally attach to the face with ear loops rather than
ties or elastic. Unlike surgical masks, procedure masks are not regulated by the Food and
Drug Administration.
Protective Environment. A specialized patient-care area or room (also known as a Positive
Pressure Room), usually in a hospital, that has a positive air flow relative to the corridor (i.e.,
air flows from the room to the outside adjacent space). The combination of high-efficiency
particulate air (HEPA) filtration, high numbers (more than 12) of air changes per hour (ACH),
and minimal leakage of air into the room creates an environment that can safely
accommodate patients/residents with a severely compromised immune system (e.g. those
who have received allogeneic hemopoietic stem-cell transplant [HSCT]) and decrease the risk
of exposure to spores produced by environmental fungi. Other components include use of
scrubbable surfaces instead of materials such as upholstery or carpeting, cleaning to prevent
dust accumulation, and prohibition of fresh flowers or potted plants.
Residential care setting. A facility in which people live, minimal medical care is delivered,
and the psychosocial needs of the residents are provided for.
Respirator. A personal protective device or mask worn by healthcare personnel to protect
them from inhalation exposure to airborne infectious agents that are more than 5 microns in
size. These include infectious droplet nuclei from patients/residents with M. tuberculosis,
variola virus [smallpox], SARS-CoV), and dust particles that contain infectious particles, such
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 212
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
as spores of environmental fungi (e.g. Aspergillus sp.). The CDC‘s National Institute for
Occupational Safety and Health (NIOSH) certifies respirators used in healthcare settings.
The N95 disposable particulate, air purifying, respirator/mask is the type used most
commonly by healthcare personnel. Other respirators used include N-99 and N-100
particulate respirators, powered air-purifying respirators (PAPRS) with high efficiency filters;
and non-powered full-face piece elastomeric negative pressure respirators. A listing of
NIOSH- approved respirators can be found at
http://www.cdc.gov/niosh/npptl/topics/respirators. Respirators must be used in conjunction
with a complete Respiratory Protection Program, as required by the Occupational Safety and
Health Administration (OSHA), that includes fit testing, training, proper selection of
respirators, medical clearance and respirator maintenance.
Respiratory Hygiene/ Cough Etiquette. A combination of measures designed to minimize
the transmission of respiratory pathogens via droplet or airborne routes in healthcare settings
and should be practiced by patients/residents, healthcare workers, and visitors. The
components of Respiratory Hygiene/Cough Etiquette are 1) covering the mouth and nose
during coughing and sneezing, 2) using tissues to contain respiratory secretions with prompt
disposal into a no-touch receptacle, 3) offering a surgical mask to persons who are coughing
to decrease contamination of the surrounding environment, and 4) turning the head away
from others and maintaining spatial separation, ideally more than 6 feet, when coughing. If a
tissue is not available, the mouth and nose can be covered by a sleeve. These measures are
targeted to all patients/residents with symptoms of respiratory infection and their
accompanying family members or friends beginning at the point of initial encounter with a
healthcare setting (e.g. reception/triage in emergency departments, ambulatory clinics,
healthcare provider offices) (Srinivasin A ICHE 2004; 25: 1020
Routine Practices (previously known as Standard or Universal Precautions). A group of
infection prevention practices that apply to all patients/residents, regardless of suspected or
confirmed diagnosis or presumed infection status. Routine Practices are based on the
principle that all blood, body fluids, secretions, excretions except sweat, non-intact skin, and
mucous membranes may contain transmissible infectious agents. Routine Practices include
hand hygiene, and depending on the anticipated exposure, use of gloves, gown, mask, eye
protection, or face shield, as well as safe injection practices. Also, equipment or items in the
patient environment likely to have been contaminated with infectious blood or body fluids
must be handled in a manner to prevent transmission of infectious agents (e.g. wear gloves
for handling, contain heavily soiled equipment, properly clean and disinfect or sterilize
reusable equipment before use on another patient).
The application of Routine Practices during patient care is determined by the nature of the
HCW-patient interaction and the extent of anticipated blood, body fluid, or pathogen
exposure. For some interactions (e.g. performing venipuncture), only gloves may be needed;
during other interactions (e.g. intubation), use of gloves, gown, and face shield or mask and
goggles is necessary. Education and training on the principles and rationale for
recommended practices are critical elements of Routine Practices because they facilitate
appropriate decision-making and promote adherence when HCWs are faced with new
circumstances. An example of the importance of the use of Routine Practices is intubation,
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 213
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
especially under emergency circumstances when infectious agents may not be suspected,
but later are identified (e.g. SARS-CoV, Neisseria meningitides). Routine Practices are also
intended to protect patients/residents by ensuring that healthcare personnel do not carry
infectious agents to patients/residents on their hands or via equipment used during patient
care.
Safety culture/climate. The shared perceptions of workers and management regarding the
expectations of safety in the work environment. A hospital safety climate includes the
following six organizational components: 1) senior management support for safety programs;
2) absence of workplace barriers to safe work practices; 3) cleanliness and orderliness of the
worksite; 4) minimal conflict and good communication among staff members; 5) frequent
safety related feedback/training by supervisors; and 6) availability of PPE and engineering
controls.
Source Control. The process of containing an infectious agent either at the portal of exit
from the body or within a confined space. The term is applied most frequently to containment
of infectious agents transmitted by the respiratory route but could apply to other routes of
transmission, (e.g. a draining wound, vesicular or bullous skin lesions). Respiratory
Hygiene/Cough Etiquette that encourages individuals to ―cover your cough‖ and/or wear a
mask is a source control measure. The use of enclosing devices for local exhaust ventilation
(e.g. booths for sputum induction or administration of aerosolized medication) is another
example of source control.
Sterilization. The only level of asepsis that kills all microbes, including spores, viruses and
TB. It includes the use of gas, chemicals, steam under pressure and radiation. Sterilization
is used on medical instruments and equipment, surgical dressing, gowns, etc
Surgical mask. A device worn over the mouth and nose by operating room personnel during
surgical procedures to protect both surgical patients/residents and operating room personnel
from transfer of microorganisms and body fluids. Surgical masks also are used to protect
healthcare personnel from contact with large infectious droplets (more than 5 microns in size).
Surgical masks are evaluated by the FDA using standardized testing procedures for fluid
resistance, bacterial filtration efficiency, differential pressure (air exchange), and flammability
in order to mitigate the risks to health associated with the use of surgical masks. These
specifications apply to any masks that are labelled surgical, laser, isolation, or dental or
medical procedure
(http://www.fda.gov/MedicalDevices/DeviceRegulationandGuidance/GuidanceDocuments/ucm072549.htm).
Surgical masks do not protect against inhalation of smaller particles and should not be
confused with particulate respirators/masks that are recommended for protection against
selected airborne infectious agents, (e.g. Mycobacterium tuberculosis).
Unit closure – a unit or area is closed to admissions and transfers in
References:
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 214
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
Siegel JD, Rhinehart E, Jackson M, Chiarello L, and the Healthcare Infection Control Practices Advisory
Committee, 2007 Guideline for Isolation Precautions: preventing Transmission of Infectious Agents in Healthcare
Settings, June 2007
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 215
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
APPENDIX C: Specific Cleaning Instructions
A.
Procedure for Cleaning Agitator Tubs/Hydrotherapy
Tanks
Prior to cleaning an agitator tub it is important to don PPE (Personal Protective Equipment).
Nursing Responsibilities (between patient use):
drain dirty water
close drain and start filling tub
when water level, covers half of whirlpool intake, turn on whirlpool pump motor
turn water off when water starts to surge out the whirlpool outlet
add manufacturer approved disinfectant (MAP) to water in the bottom of tub (follow
manufacturers‘ directions on concentration and amount) and let the whirlpool run for
one minute
wash/scrub the interior of tub with brush/mop and the disinfectant in tub
swing chair over tub and clean with disinfectant
drain the system
shower down interior of tub and chair with clean water and back flush the pump
wipe down chair with clean cloth.
End of the Day Cleaning (Housekeeping Staff)
fill tub with water to point midway between chair and overflow
add manufacturers approved cleaning agent at appropriate strength to the water
lower chair into water
activate whirlpool for 3 – 5 minutes
scrub and clean all surfaces of chair(s)
rinse the chair thoroughly and drain the tub
drain the system
shower down interior of tub and chair with clean water and back flush the pump
wipe down chair with clean cloth
B.
Procedure for Cleaning Fans
Fans must not be used in Acute Patient Care settings. When fans are used in other settings,
they must have a removable fan blade grill cover. When the fan is no longer required, or at a
minimum once per month, the grill cover must be removed and the fan blades cleaned with
the approved disinfectant wipes. When the grill is replaced, all surfaces of the fan including
the base and electrical cord are cleaned and sanitized. A dust cover is placed over the fan
head. The fan must be sent to Facilities Maintenance and Operations annually for inspection
and maintenance.
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 216
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
C.
Procedure for Cleaning Commodes
Nursing Responsibilities
Contact surfaces of the commode (seat, armrests, and basin) must be cleaned and
sanitized following each patient use. The approved disinfectant ready to use wipes
must be readily available for this purpose.
When a commode dedicated for patient use is no longer required by the patient,
housekeeping is notified and a completed ―Housekeeping: cleaning and disinfection
required‖ sign is placed on the chair to prevent use by another patient. (A sign is being
developed.)
Housekeeping Responsibilities
Upon notification by nursing staff, the commode will be removed from circulation and
taken for cleaning and disinfection. Chairs that are constructed to withstand power
washing or automated washing in a machine designed for this purpose may be
processed in this manner, where such equipment is available.
When manual cleaning is done, all surfaces must be cleaned and then disinfected.
NOTE: If the chair is found to be in a state of disrepair or surfaces are cracked, the chair cannot be adequately
cleaned. This must be brought to the attention of the nursing manager or leader so that repair or replacement
can be facilitated.
D.
Procedure for Cleaning Suction Regulators
Procedure for ensuring safe Infection Prevention and Control practices to ensure appropriate
use of wall mounted suction equipment:
Hard Plastic Reusable Suction Canisters with fixed red tubing and fixed wall attachment along
with the single-use inner liners, red lids, and sealed suction tubing packages are placed in all
patient rooms. If used during the patient‘s admission, the Hard Plastic Reusable Suction
Canister with fixed red tubing and wall attachment is taken to the Dirty Utility Room cleaned
and returned to the patient bedside. The single-use inner liners, red lids, and suction tubing
are removed and discarded upon discharge. A new single-use liner and red lid is placed
within the clean hard outer canister and a new sealed suction tubing package is placed at the
bedside.
Hard Plastic Reusable Suction Canister with fixed red tubing and fixed wall attachment with
single-use inner liners and red lids within patient rooms that are not used are surface wiped
at discharge. The outside of the sealed suction tubing packaging is surface wiped upon
patient discharge. The sealed suction tubing packaging is an indicator that the suction bottle
was NOT used. If the Hard Plastic Reusable Suction Canister with fixed red tubing and wall
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 217
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
attachment and the single-use inner liners and red lids are clean and the suction tubing
package is open, discard the suction tubing
Within the Endoscopy suite, staff will cleans the Hard Plastic Reusable Suction Canisters with
fixed red tubing and fixed wall attachment and discard the single-use inner liners, red lids,
and the suction tubing between every patient case.
N.B. The Hard Plastic Reusable Suction Canisters with fixed red tubing and fixed wall
attachment are manufactured and sold as a reusable item. The Suction Canister inner liners
and sealed suction tubing packages are manufactured, sold, and labeled as single-use items
(i.e. one patient only).
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 218
VIHA Infection Prevention and Control Manual, September 1, 2011
RECENT CHANGES/ADDITIONS
September 1 – Updated the ILI Outbreak Suspected Case Definition
April 7, 2011
Update to Table 10-Procedure for Discontinuing Additional Precautions (revised since
the March 16 update)
Added a hyperlink to the Intranet‘s listing of the negative pressure rooms throughout
VIHA at the beginning of the Airborne Precautions section
Change to the short list of examples mentioned in the introduction to Airborne
Precautions
Added gown and gloves to the first bullet that touches on the recommend PPE for staff
when Droplet Precautions are in place
Added the last bullet in the column for visitors when contact, droplet and airborne
precautions are in place
Substituted many of the points about staff working restrictions during a GI/Norovirus
outbreak with a hyperlink to an easy-to-follow algorithm
Updated the recommendations for visitors/volunteers during GI Illness Outbreak and
during an ILI Outbreak
Updated the length of time that housekeeping needs to wait (now 4 days rather than 5
days) after a GI/Norovirus Outbreak before starting their precaution cleaning
Changed ―patient‖ to ―patient/resident‖ throughout as this manual is applicable to both
Acute and Residential sites
April 1, 2011 – the ARO Screening Questionnaire replaces the old MRSA Screening
Questionnaire
March 14, 2011 – procedures surrounding magazines/books/puzzles
February 22, 2011 – addition of Precaution Table
February 8, 2011 – updated mask information for patients/residents and visitors when
Airborne Precautions are in place
February 2, 2011 – additional housekeeping information for CDH, NRHG and the PCC at RJH
January 31, 2011 – change to the Nasopharyngeal Swab procedure
Note: In this document the term ―patient‖ is inclusive of patient, resident or client.
Page 219